unique prosthetic solutions
Product Catalogue Prosthetic Components, Orthoses and Materials valid from January 2013
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
unique prosthetic solutions
Contents 1 Prosthetics
1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 1.10
Prosthetic Feet Modular Adapters Functional Adapters Prosthetic Knee Joints Hip Joints Liners and Locking Devices Cosmetic Covers Stump Socks Valves Socket Accessories
7 25 43 45 63 65 87 91 105 111
- - - - - - - - - -
24 42 44 62 64 86 90 104 110 112
113 119 121 125 131 141
- - - - - -
118 120 124 130 140 142
143 153 169 173 187 191
- - - - - -
152 168 172 186 190 196
2 Orthotics
2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6
Ankle and Foot Orthoses Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO) Hip Orthoses Spinal Orthoses Hand Orthoses Cervical Orthoses
3 Materials
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6
Plaster Fabrication Materials Lamination Materials Plastic Sheet Materials Padding Materials Other Materials Tools
4 Measurement Sheets
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
197 - 203
The Uniprox service concept
It is our aim also to ensure the quality of patient care, for the future as well. This can only be achieved by working with specialist suppliers who want to provide their customers with the best possible care as rapidly as possible. Our service concept has been approved precisely with the following in mind: efficient transactions, the best advice and tailor-made solutions for providing care. Our sales staff can competently answer product-specific and business questions and are our contacts for joint marketing concepts. To make a rapid search or for convenient online ordering all the necessary information can be found at www.uniprox.de.
Jennifer Fischer
Customer Service
+49 (0) 36628-66-33 70
Fax
+49 (0) 36628-66-33 77
export@uniprox.de
3
Prosthetic Components, Orthoses and Materials
Mobility, one step at a time.
We have been supplying orthotists and prosthetists with prosthetic components since 2001. We specialize in the prosthetic support of the lower extremities. We work closely with the Bauerfeind Innovation Center, prosthetists/orthotists, physicians and scientists to develop high-quality products that enable amputees to acquire more mobility, and therefore a better quality of life. With our products we take a systematic approach to mobility management, meeting patients‘ needs at every stage of their rehabilitation. The patient‘s mobility level determines which prosthetic components are needed. We classify feet, knee and hip joints according to four mobility levels.
Innovative Solutions Our development efforts translate into innovative solutions for supplying customers with prosthetic components. For example, the polycentric JT20 knee joint makes it possible for patients to switch from a stable geometry to a more dynamic one, so it can be utilized for a wide range of needs. With the monocentric JT09 safety knee the spring extension assist can be adjusted on the outside with a setting ring. Both joints are approved for a total weight of 150 kilograms which means prosthetists/orthotists can use them for a wide range of applications.
Quality It is our company‘s philosophy to constantly improve our products and optimize our processes. All products from the Prosthetics and Orthoses segments meet the requirements of the German Medical Devices Act and bear the CE marking.
4
mobi 4 Life – Mobility Management, Prosthetic Selection Criteria The mobi 4 LIFE selection system is used to classify the functional components of a prostheses like prosthetic feet, knees and hip joints according to four mobility levels and the weight of the patient. This optimizes prosthetic care both for the prosthetist/orthotist and for the patient. To orthotists/prosthetists mobi 4 Life offers the option of easily customizing the functional prosthetic components to the unique needs of the patient. mobi 4 Life also makes it easy for orthotists/prosthetists to order products because the mobility level and weight class allowed for each component can be identified at a glance. Furthermore, with mobi 4 LIFE billing can be more objectively verified for the paying party. mobi 4 LIFE gives patients the confidence that the components have been selected according to his or her individual needs and that an ideal prosthetic solution has been found. Structural components like adapters and tubes are also classified according the patient‘s usage weight.
Mobility Classification Guide The mobility levels 1 to 4 are based on the activity of the amputee and therefore the load which is applied to a lower extremity prosthesis.*
Mobility Level 1 Indoor Walker
Mobility Level 2 Restricted Outdoor Walker
Mobility Level 3 Unrestricted Outdoor Walker
Mobility Level 4 Unrestricted Outdoor Walker with High Demands
The patient can walk slowly with the prosthesis on even surfaces. The patient can only walk short distances for short periods of time. Goal of prosthetic fitting: Restore the standing ability and limited ambulation indoors.
The patient has the ability to move with low to medium walking speed. He or she is able to easily overcome small obstacles such as curbs or single steps. The distance covered and the duration of time while walking are limited. Goal of prosthetic fitting: Restore the standing ability and limited ambulation indoors and outdoors. The patient has the ability to move with medium to high walking speed on uneven surfaces and open terrain. However, above-average performance is not possible. Goal of prosthetic fitting: Restore the standing ability and unlimited ambulation indoors and limited ambulation outdoors. The patient moves without restrictions at any speed. The greater mobility generates high impact, tension and/or deformation load on the prosthesis. Goal of prosthetic fitting: Restore standing ability, unlimited ambulation and mobilization indoors and outdoors.
C l a s s i f i c a t i o n o f t h e F u n c t i o n a l C o m p o n e n t s A c c o r d i n g t o We i g h t C l a s s e s For each component the weight of the patient plays a significant role. The combination of the patient‘s weight and mobility level determines the load that the component must carry. This is why it is crucial to have precise weight specifications.
Our classifications: Max. patient weight
*The classification of mobility (activity levels) is done according to the parameters given by the German Health Insurance Association (MDS). 5
6
unique prosthetic solutions
1 Prosthetics 1.1
Prosthetic Feet
1.2
Modular Adapters
1.3
Functional Adapters
1.4
Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.5
Hip Joints
1.6
Liners and Locking Devices
1.7
Cosmetic Covers
1.8
Stump Socks
1.9
Valves
1.10
Socket Accessories
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
F1 SACH Foot for Men with separated toe • The SACH (Solid Ankle Cushion Heel) Foot has a plastic core and an outer flexible molded foot shell
Order No. Size / Side F1-
Available Sizes
Heel Height (A)
Installation Height (E)
Weight (depending on size)
Heel Bumper
Article No.
22–29
10 mm
70 mm
360–585 g
integrated
4 101 010 0X 00 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F1, size: 26, side: right Order No.: F1-26R
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right ZZ = Size (See Available Sizes) Example: Foot F1, side: right, size: 26, Article No.: 4 101 010 02 00 026
F10 Dynamic SACH Foot Proximal Pyramid Adapter • The SACH (Solid Ankle Cushion Heel) Foot has an inner core reinforced with carbon-kevlar and an external flexible molded foot shell • With proximal pyramid adapter
Order No. Size / Side F10-
Available Sizes
Heel Height (A)
Installation Height (E)
Weight (depending on size)
Heel Bumper
Article No.
24–29
18 mm
70 mm
695–955 g
integrated
4 101 100 0X 00 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F10 in size: 26, side: left Order No.: F10-26L 8
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right ZZ = Size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F10, side: left, size: 26, Article No.: 4 101 100 01 00 026
1.2 Modular Adapters
F20 Dynamic SACH Foot with separated toe
F20-
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Available Sizes
Heel Height (A)
Installation Height (E)
Weight (depending on size)
Heel Bumper
Article No.
22–29
10 mm
70 mm
425–605 g
integrated
4 101 200 0X 00 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F20 in size: 28, side: right Order No.: F20-28R
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F20, side: right, size: 28, Article No.: 4 101 200 02 00 028
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Accessories and Spare Parts for SACH Feet
1.5 Hip Joints
Size / Side
1.3 Functional Adapters
• The SACH (Solid Ankle Cushion Heel) Foot has a special foam-filled plastic core which provides more dynamic energy than conventional SACH feet • Very light and cosmetically appealing prosthetic foot which has high stance-phase stability and is very comfortable
Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
2
Weight limit
Connector
Ausführung
Article No.
Pict.
E-F01
pyramid
Al/M10
4 101 019 99 11 010
1
E-F02
pyramid
Steel/M10
4 101 019 99 22 010
1
E-F04
pyramid
Titanium/M10
4 101 019 99 33 010
1
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
Modular SACH Foot Adapter for Men‘s Feet F1 and F20, includes bolt assemblies
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
E-F19
plastic
4 101 079 00 00 000
2 9
1.10 Socket Accessories
Connection Plate
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
Accessories and Spare Parts for SACH Feet
3
4
Bolt Assemblies for Ankle Blocks
Ankle blocks, incl. bolt assemblies
Feet for Men
Feet for Men
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
E-F08
M10x90
4 101 049 00 00 010
3
E-F10
Wood/M10
4 101 059 00 77 000
4
Feet for Women
Feet for Women
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
E-F09
M8x90
4 101 049 00 00 008
3
E-F12
Wood/M8
4 101 069 00 77 000
4
10
1.2 Modular Adapters
F30 Uniprox Light Foot
< 136 kg
24–29
F30-
Heel Height
Installation Height outside
Installation Height inside
Keel
Weight Size 27
Article No.
10 mm
72 mm
38 mm
6–8
425 g
4 601 010 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F30, size: 29, side: right, keel 8 Order No.: F30-29R8
Selection of keel
e XosK el e Ta l
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F30, side: right, keel 8, size: 29, Article No.: 4 601 010 02 08 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Size/Side/Keel
Available Size
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
• Delrin keel • Flexible foot shell • Including foot bolt M 10x55
Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
! Smaller sizes on request. CoMP o n en T s
Weight (kg) 7
7
8
Seattle Ankle Block
Child’s Play® Ankle Block
The seattle ankle block is designed for use with seattle feet in
8 8 < 136exoskeletal construction. Manufactured using high strength rigid polyurethane foam surrounding a nylon core, the ankle block is lightweight and durable to withstand the forces imposed by dynamic response feet. • sab3 0 is appropriate for the lightfoot² and Carbon lightfoot • sab3 0 is appropriate for the lifecast, ladies’ foot, natural foot, and saCH foot • largest width: 4 mm (4- / ”) • Weight limit: 36 kg (300 lb) • Core diameter: 5 mm ( ”)
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
6
< 120
The Child’s Play® ankle block is designed for the exoskeletal construction of the Child’s Play® foot. Manufactured using a high strength rigid polyurethane foam surrounding a nylon core, the ankle block is lightweight yet durable to withstand the forces imposed by dynamic response feet. • largest width: 79 mm (3- /8”) • Height: 89 mm (3- / ”) • Weight limit: 65 kg ( 44 lb)
3
Model #
Description
Height
sab3 0
standard ankle block
( 4 mm) 4-7/8” 4 6 g (86 mm) 3-3/8” 369 g
low Profile ankle block Order sab3 0 No. Description
1.8 Stump Socks
2 Product Wt
Model #
Foot Size
Core Diameter
sab3 sab3 sab3 3
3- 5 cm 6- 8 cm 9- cm
30 mm ( -3/ 6”) 3 g 35 mm ( -3/8”) 46 g 4 mm ( -5/8”) g Article 79 No.
Product Weight
Pict.
Ankle block from plastic
4 601 019 00 00 001
1
Spacer block with screw E-F63Seattle Laminating Core
4 601 019 00 00 004 Child’s Play® Laminating Core
2
adapter, with low screw E-F62The seattlePyramid laminating Core is titanium, a high-strength, profile
4 601 019low 00profile 00 003 The Child’s Play® laminating Core is a high-strength,
3
E-F60
alternative to the seattle ankle block. Requiring minimal keel to socket clearance, the laminating Core is laminated directly to the socket.
1.9 Valves
1
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Accessories and Spare Parts for F30 Uniprox Light Foot
alternative to the ankle block. Requiring minimal keel to socket clearance, the laminating core is laminated directly to the socket, providing adaptation to the Child’s Play® foot.
• appropriate feet include the lifecast, ladies’ foot, natural foot, saCH foot, lightfoot², and Carbon lightfoot
11
1.10 Socket Accessories
< 100
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
F35 Uniprox Lifecast Foot • • • • •
4 different hardness grades (depending on weight) J-shaped core Realistic cosmetic foot cover Including foot bolt M 10x55 The design is based on natural shapes of feet. Due to this the actual foot length can vary in size and length.
< 114 kg
Order No Size/Side/Keel F35-
Available Size
Heel Height
Installation Height Size 23-26
Installation Height Size 27-29
Keel
Weight Size 25
Article No.
23–29
19 mm
81 mm
89 mm
3-6
532 g
4 601 030 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F35, size: 26, side: right, keel 6 Order No.: F35-26R6
Selection of keel
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F35, side: right, keel 6, size: 26, Article No.: 4 601 030 02 06 026
! Smaller sizes on request. Size 27-29
Keel
Size 23-26
3
< 70 kg
< 69 kg
4
70-83 kg
69-81 kg
5
84-99 kg
82-92 kg
6
100-114 kg
93-111 kg
Accessories and Spare Parts for F35 Uniprox Lifecast Foot
1
2
3
Order No
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-F08
Bolt assemblies for ankle blocks, M10X90
4 101 049 00 00 010
1
E-F10
ankle block incl. bolt assemblies, wood/M10
4 101 059 00 77 000
2
E-F62
Pyramid adapter, titanium, with screw
4 601 019 00 00 003
3
12
1.2 Modular Adapters
F40 Uniprox Carbon Light Foot
< 124 kg
24–29
F40-
Heel Height
Installation Height outside
Installation Height inside
Keel
Weight Size 27
Article No.
10 mm
72 mm
38 mm
2-3
405 g
4 601 020 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F40, size: 29, side: right, keel 2 Order No.: F40-29R2
Selection of keel
e XosK el e Ta l
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F40, side: right, keel 2, size: 29, Article No.: 4 601 010 02 08 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Size/Side/Keel
Available Size
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
• Carbonfiber reinforced keel • Flexible foot shell • Including foot bolt M 10x55
Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
CoMP o n en T s
2
< 124
3
Seattle Ankle Block
Child’s Play® Ankle Block
The seattle ankle block is designed for use with seattle feet in exoskeletal construction. Manufactured using high strength rigid polyurethane foam surrounding a nylon core, the ankle block is lightweight and durable to withstand the forces imposed by dynamic response feet.
The Child’s Play® ankle block is designed for the exoskeletal construction of the Child’s Play® foot. Manufactured using a high strength rigid polyurethane foam surrounding a nylon core, the ankle block is lightweight yet durable to withstand the forces imposed by dynamic response feet.
• sab3 0 is appropriate for the lightfoot² and Carbon lightfoot • sab3 0 is appropriate for the lifecast, ladies’ foot, natural foot, and saCH foot • largest width: 4 mm (4- / ”) • Weight limit: 36 kg (300 lb) • Core diameter: 5 mm ( ”)
• largest width: 79 mm (3- /8”) • Height: 89 mm (3- / ”) • Weight limit: 65 kg ( 44 lb)
3
Model #
Description
Height
sab3 0
standard ankle block
( 4 mm) 4-7/8” 4 6 g (86 mm) 3-3/8” 369 g
low Profile ankle block Order sab3 0 No. Description
1.8 Stump Socks
2 Product Wt
Model #
Foot Size
Core Diameter
sab3 sab3 sab3 3
3- 5 cm 6- 8 cm 9- cm
30 mm ( -3/ 6”) 3 g 35 mm ( -3/8”) 46 g 4 mm ( -5/8”) g Article 79 No.
Product Weight
Pict.
Ankle block from plastic
4 601 019 00 00 001
1
Spacer block with screw E-F63Seattle Laminating Core
4 601 019 00 00 004 Child’s Play® Laminating Core
2
adapter, with low screw E-F62The seattlePyramid laminating Core is titanium, a high-strength, profile
4 601 019low 00profile 00 003 The Child’s Play® laminating Core is a high-strength,
3
E-F60
alternative to the seattle ankle block. Requiring minimal keel to socket clearance, the laminating Core is laminated directly to the socket.
1.9 Valves
1
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Accessories and Spare Parts for F40 Uniprox Carbon Light Foot
alternative to the ankle block. Requiring minimal keel to socket clearance, the laminating core is laminated directly to the socket, providing adaptation to the Child’s Play® foot.
• appropriate feet include the lifecast, ladies’ foot, natural foot, saCH foot, lightfoot², and Carbon lightfoot
13
1.10 Socket Accessories
< 100
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Weight (kg)
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
F50 Uniprox Single-Axis-Foot • Integrated ankle joint • Splitted big toe • Accessories: A5 tube adapter with pyramid
< 136 kg
Order No size/side/bumper F50-
Available Size
Heel Height
Installation Height
Bumper
Weight Size 27
Artikelnummer
24–30
10 mm
72 mm
1-4
425 g
4 602 012 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F50, size:29, side: right, bumper 2 Order No.: F50-29R2
Selection of bumpers
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = bumper ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F50,side: right, bumper 2, size: 29, Article No.: 4 602 012 02 02 029
! Smaller sizes on request.
Weight (kg) < 60
1
< 60-80
2
< 80-100
3
< 100-136
4
Accessories and Spare Parts for F50 Uniprox Single-Axis-Foot Accessories Order No.
Description
Article No.
A5
Tube adapter with pyramid, 30 mm, Length 455 mm, Weight 320 g
4 620 010 00 00 000
E-F50-T
Maintenance kit for F50
4 602 019 00 29 000
E-F50-M
Tool-Set
4 602 019 00 30 000
E-F50-G
Ankle joint
4 602 019 00 37 000
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F50-P1
Bumper, soft
4 602 019 00 01 000
E-F50-P2
Bumper, medium
4 602 019 00 02 000
E-F50-P3
Bumper, firm
4 602 019 00 03 000
E-F50-P4
Bumper, x-firm
4 602 019 00 04 000
Bumper
14
1.3 Functional Adapters
Carbonfiber-Foot 3 heel heights Splitted toe spring High energy return
< 166 kg
Size/Side/Keel F60-
Available Size
Heel Height outside
Heel wedges inside variable
24–29
10 mm
6,5 mm; 10 mm; 13 mm 180 mm
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F60, size: 29, side: right, keel 3 Order No.: F60-29R3
Selection of keel
Installation Height
Keel Weight Size 27 3-5
735 g
Article No.
4 603 012 0X 0Y 0ZZ
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F60, side: right, keel 2, size: 29, Article No.: 4 603 012 02 08 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
• • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
F60 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
! Smaller sizes on request.
< 100
3
4
4
< 136
4
4
5
< 166
5
5
5
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Weight (kg)
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Accessories and Spare Parts for F60 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F60-T
Component Kit for F60 (look at the instruction for use)
4 603 019 0028 000
E-F60-W
Tool Kit for F60/F70 (look at the instruction for use)
4 603 019 00 29 000
E-F60-SL
Uniprox Shoe Horn
4 603 019 00 38 000
E-F60-SS
Spectra-Sock for F60/F70
4 603 019 00 39 000
E-F60-A
Heel wedges-Set
4 603 019 00 40 000
1.8 Stump Socks
Accessories
Description
Article No.
E-F60-CK2
Cord Kit for F60
4 603 019 00 30 000
E-F60-CK3
Cord Kit for F60
4 603 019 00 31 000
E-F60-CK4
Cord Kit for F60
4 603 019 00 32 000
E-F60-CK5
Cord Kit for F60
4 603 019 00 33 000
15
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.9 Valves
Cord Kit (to be changed every two years; see instruction manual)
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet Foot shell F60 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-F60-24L
24
left
4 603 019 01 00 024
E-F60-25L
25
left
4 603 019 01 00 025
E-F60-26L
26
left
4 603 019 01 00 026
E-F60-27L
27
left
4 603 019 01 00 027
E-F60-28L
28
left
4 603 019 01 00 028
E-F60-29L
29
left
4 603 019 01 00 029
E-F60-30L
30
left
4 603 019 01 00 030
E-F60-24R
24
right
4 603 019 02 00 024
E-F60-25R
25
right
4 603 019 02 00 025
E-F60-26R
26
right
4 603 019 02 00 026
E-F60-27R
27
right
4 603 019 02 00 027
E-F60-28R
28
right
4 603 019 02 00 028
E-F60-29R
29
right
4 603 019 02 00 029
E-F60-30R
30
right
4 603 019 02 00 030
16
NEW
< 136 kg
Size/Side/Keel F63-
Available Size
Heel Height
Installation Height
Keel
Weight Size 25 without foot shell
Article No.
25–29
10 mm
70 mm
1-4
330 g
4 603 030 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F63 in size 27, side right, keel 3 Order No.: F63-27R3
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Examble: Foot F63, side right, Keel 3, side 27, Article No.: 4 603 030 02 03 027
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
Weight (kg)
1
< 60
2
61 - 81
3
81 - 100
4
101 - 136
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
! Smaller sizes on request. Keel
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.3 Functional Adapters
• Splitted toe dynamic forefoot spring for a high level of stance stability • Cushioned heel thanks to integrated foamed heel bumper • Natural-looking cosmetic foot cover with toes and a separate big toe • Integrated pyramid adapter made of titanium
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
F63 Uniprox Carbon Foot
1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Accessories and Spare Parts for F63 Uniprox Carbon Foot
Side
Article No.
25
left
4 603 039 01 00 025
E-F63-26L
26
left
4 603 039 01 00 026
E-F63-27L
27
left
4 603 039 01 00 027
E-F63-28L
28
left
4 603 039 01 00 028
E-F63-29L
29
left
4 603 039 01 00 029
E-F63-25R
25
right
4 603 039 02 00 025
E-F63-26R
26
right
4 603 039 02 00 026
E-F63-27R
27
right
4 603 039 02 00 027
E-F63-28R
28
right
4 603 039 02 00 028
E-F63-29R
29
right
4 603 039 02 00 029
1.9 Valves
Size
E-F63-25L
17
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
Foot shell F63 Uniprox Carbon Foot
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
F65 Uniprox Low Profile • • • •
Low-profile carbon-spring foot Multiaxial C-shaped spring for anatomical plantar flexion Full length, split composite keel for stability Removable cosmetic foot cover with Spectra Sock
NEW
< 136 kg
Order No. Size/Side/Keel F65-
Available Size
Heel Height
Installation Height
Keel
Weight Size 25 without foot shell
Article No.
25–29
10 mm
75 mm
1-4
400 g
4 603 040 0X 0Y 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F65, size: 27, side: right, keel 3 Bestell-Nr.: F65-27R3
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F65, side: right, keel 3, size: 27, Artikelnummer: 4 603 040 02 03 027
! Smaller sizes on request.
Keel Walking on uneven surfaces
Gentle sporting activities
Strenuous sporting activities
4*
101 - 136 kg
88 - 118 kg
81 - 109 kg
3
81 - 100 kg
74 - 87 kg
68 - 80 kg
2
61 - 80 kg
56 - 73 kg
51 - 67 kg
1
< 60 kg
< 55 kg
< 50 kg
*available in size 26 - 29
Accessories and Spare Parts for F65 Uniprox Low Profile Spare Parts Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F65-W
Service-Set for F65 (look at the instruction for use)
4 603 049 00 41 000
Foot shell F65 Uniprox Low Profile
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-F65-25L
25
left
4 603 049 01 00 025
E-F65-26L
26
left
4 603 049 01 00 026
E-F65-27L
27
left
4 603 049 01 00 027
E-F65-28L
28
left
4 603 049 01 00 028
E-F65-29L
29
left
4 603 049 01 00 029
E-F65-25R
25
right
4 603 049 02 00 025
E-F65-26R
26
right
4 603 049 02 00 026
E-F65-27R
27
right
4 603 049 02 00 027
E-F65-28R
28
right
4 603 049 02 00 028
E-F65-29R
29
right
4 603 049 02 00 029
18
1.3 Functional Adapters
Splitted toe spring Shockabsorbing Easy Roll-on High energy return
< 166 kg
Size/Side/Keel F70-
Available Size
Heel Height outside
Heel wedges inside variable
24–29
10 mm
6,5 mm; 10 mm; 13 mm 180 mm
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F70, size: 29, side: right, keel 3 Order No.: F70-29R3
Installation Height
Keel Weight Size 27
Article No.
3-9
4 603 022 0X 0Y 0ZZ
735 g
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right , Y = keel ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F70, side: right, keel 3, size: 29, Article No.: 4 603 022 03 08 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
• • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
F70 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
! Smaller sizes on request.
Selection of keel
106-125 kg
8
121-140 kg
106-123 kg
91-105 kg
7
101-120 kg
89-105 kg
76-90 kg
6
91-100 kg
80-88 kg
69-75 kg
5
81-90 kg
71-79 kg
61-68 kg
4
71-80 kg
62-70 kg
53-60 kg
3
66-70 kg
58-61 kg
50-53 kg
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
124-145 kg
Accessories and Spare Parts for F70 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot Accessories Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F60-T
Component Kit for F60 (look at the instruction for use)
4 603 019 0028 000
E-F60-W
Tool Kit for F60/F70 (look at the instruction for use)
4 603 019 00 29 000
E-F60-SL
Uniprox Shoe Horn
4 603 019 00 38 000
E-F60-SS
Spectra-Sock for F60/F70
4 603 019 00 39 000
E-F60-A
Heel wedges-Set
4 603 019 00 40 000
1.8 Stump Socks
141-166 kg
1.9 Valves
9
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Key
Order No.
Description
Size
Article No.
E-F70-CK2
Cord Kit for F70
small
4 603 029 00 19 300
E-F70-CK3
Cord Kit for F70
small
4 603 029 00 19 500
E-F70-CK5
Cord Kit for F70
small
4 603 029 00 19 700 19
1.10 Socket Accessories
Cord Kit(to be changed every two years; see instruction manual)
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
Cord Kit (to be changed every two years; see instruction manual) Order No.
Description
Size
Article no.
E-F70-CK6
Cord Kit for F70
small
4 603 029 00 19 900
E-F70-CK8
Cord Kit for F70
middle
4 603 029 00 20 300
E-F70-CK9
Cord Kit for F70
medium
4 603 029 00 20 500
E-F70-CK11
Cord Kit for F70
medium
4 603 029 00 20 700
E-F70-CK12
Cord Kit for F70
medium
4 603 029 00 20 900
E-F70-CK14
Cord Kit for F70
large
4 603 029 00 21 300
E-F70-CK15
Cord Kit for F70
large
4 603 029 00 21 500
E-F70-CK17
Cord Kit for F70
large
4 603 029 00 21 700
E-F70-CK18
Cord Kit for F70
large
4 603 029 00 21 900
Foot shell F70 Uniprox Carbonfiber-Foot
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-F60-24L
24
left
4 603 019 01 00 024
E-F60-25L
25
left
4 603 019 01 00 025
E-F60-26L
26
left
4 603 019 01 00 026
E-F60-27L
27
left
4 603 019 01 00 027
E-F60-28L
28
left
4 603 019 01 00 028
E-F60-29L
29
left
4 603 019 01 00 029
E-F60-30L
30
left
4 603 019 01 00 030
E-F60-24R
24
right
4 603 019 02 00 024
E-F60-25R
25
right
4 603 019 02 00 025
E-F60-26R
26
right
4 603 019 02 00 026
E-F60-27R
27
right
4 603 019 02 00 027
E-F60-28R
28
right
4 603 019 02 00 028
E-F60-29R
29
right
4 603 019 02 00 029
E-F60-30R
30
right
4 603 019 02 00 030
20
1.3 Functional Adapters
Multiaxial Foot Individual bumper configuration axial, anterior and posterior Delivery with standard bumper configuration Incl. bumper-set Easy change of bumpers without tools
< 95 kg
F80-
Available Size
Heel Height outside
Installation Height
Weight Size 27
Article No.
24–30
10 mm
130 mm
790 g
4 602 020 0X 00 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F80, size: 29, side: right Order No.: F80-29R
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F80, side: right, size: 29, Article No.: 4 602 020 02 00 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Size/Side
Selection of bumpers (shore hardness) 77 - 95 Kg
Front
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
85
85
55
95
95
65
95
95
75
85
85
65
95
95
75
95
95
75
85
85
65
95
95
75
95
95
75
Bumper Front (F)
Bumper Center (C)
Bumper Back(B)
95 Shore A
95 Shore A
75 Shore A
85 Shore A
85 Shore A
65 Shore A
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Activity Level 3 Activity Level 4
55 Shore A
Bumper Center (C)
Bumper Back (B)
1.8 Stump Socks
Activity Level 2
69 - 76 Kg
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
41 - 68 Kg
Bumper Front (F)
1.9 Valves
Weight Activity Level
21
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
• • • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
F80 Uniprox Multiaxial Foot
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
Accessories and Spare Parts for F80 Uniprox Multiaxial Foot Accessories Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F80-OR
O-Ring
4 602 029 00 00 001
E-F80-WS
Component Kit for F80/F90
4 602 029 00 29 000
E-F80-SS
Spectra-Sock for F80
4 602 029 00 39 000
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F80-PV2
Bumper anterior 85 shore
4 602 029 00 02 000
E-F80-PV3
Bumper anterior 95 shore
4 602 029 00 03 000
E-F80-PM1
Bumper axial 85 shore
4 602 029 00 05 000
E-F80-PM2
Bumper axial 95 shore
4 602 029 00 06 000
E-F80-PH1
Bumper posterior 55 shore
4 602 029 00 16 000
E-F80-PH2
Bumper posterior 65 shore
4 602 029 00 17 000
E-F80-PH3
Bumper posterior 75 shore
4 602 029 00 18 000
E-F80-PH4
Bumper posterior 85 shore
4 602 029 00 19 000
E-F80-PS
Bumper Set for F80 and F90
4 602 029 00 28 000
Bumper
Foot shell
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-F80-24L
24
left
4 602 029 01 00 024
E-F80-25L
25
left
4 602 029 01 00 025
E-F80-26L
26
left
4 602 029 01 00 026
E-F80-27L
27
left
4 602 029 01 00 027
E-F80-28L
28
left
4 602 029 01 00 028
E-F80-29L
29
left
4 602 029 01 00 029
E-F80-30L
30
left
4 602 029 01 00 030
E-F80-24R
24
right
4 602 029 02 00 024
E-F80-25R
25
right
4 602 029 02 00 025
E-F80-26R
26
right
4 602 029 02 00 026
E-F80-27R
27
right
4 602 029 02 00 027
E-F80-28R
28
right
4 602 029 02 00 028
E-F80-29R
29
right
4 602 029 02 00 029
E-F80-30R
30
right
4 602 029 02 00 030
Foot shell connection plate
Order No.
Description
Size
Article No.
E-F80-AP1
Connection plate, small
24-26
4 602 029 00 00 002
E-F80-AP2
Connection plate, big
27-30
4 602 029 00 00 003
22
F90-
1.3 Functional Adapters
Available Size
Heel Height outside
Installation Height
Weight Size 27
Article No.
24–30
10 mm
135 mm
810 g
4 602 030 0X 00 0ZZ
Side: L = left, R = right Example: Foot F90, size: 29, side: right Order No.: F90-29R
X = side: 1 = left, 2 = right ZZ = size (See available sizes) Example: Foot F90, side: right, size: 29, Article No.: 4 602 030 02 00 029
1.5 Hip Joints
Size/Side
Selection of bumpers (shore hardness) 69 - 76 Kg
77 - 95 Kg
96 -112 Kg
113 - 125 Kg
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
Front
Center
Back
85
85
55
95
95
65
95
95
75
95
95
75
95
95
75
Activity Level 3
85
85
65
95
95
75
95
95
75
95
95
75
95
95
85
Activity Level 4
85
85
65
95
95
75
95
95
75
95
95
85
95
95
85
Bumper Front (F)
Bumper Center (C)
Bumper Back(B)
95 Shore A
95 Shore A
85 Shore A
85 Shore A
85 Shore A
75 Shore A
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Front Activity Level 2
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
41-68 Kg
65 Shore A
Bumper Center (C)
1.8 Stump Socks
55 Shore A
Bumper Back (B)
Bumper Front (F)
1.9 Valves
Weight Activity Level
23
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
Multiaxial Carbonfiber-Foot Individual bumper configuration axial, anterior and posterior Delivery with standard bumper configuration Incl. bumper-set Easy change of bumpers without tools
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
• • • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
F90 Uniprox Multiaxial Carbonfiber-Foot
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.1 Prosthetic Feet
Accessories and Spare Parts for F90 Uniprox Multiaxial Carbonfiber-Foot Accessories Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F80-OR
O-Ring
4 602 029 00 00 001
E-F80-WS
Component Kit for F80/F90
4 602 029 00 29 000
E-F80-SS
Spectra-Sock for F80
4 602 029 00 39 000
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-F80-PV2
Bumper anterior 85 shore
4 602 029 00 02 000
E-F80-PV3
Bumper anterior 95 shore
4 602 029 00 03 000
E-F80-PM1
Bumper axial 85 shore
4 602 029 00 05 000
E-F80-PM2
Bumper axial 95 shore
4 602 029 00 06 000
E-F80-PH1
Bumper posterior 55 shore
4 602 029 00 16 000
E-F80-PH2
Bumper posterior 65 shore
4 602 029 00 17 000
E-F80-PH3
Bumper posterior 75 shore
4 602 029 00 18 000
E-F80-PH4
Bumper posterior 85 shore
4 602 029 00 19 000
E-F80-PS
Bumper Set for F80 and F90
4 602 029 00 28 000
Bumper
Foot shell
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-F80-24L
24
left
4 602 029 01 00 024
E-F80-25L
25
left
4 602 029 01 00 025
E-F80-26L
26
left
4 602 029 01 00 026
E-F80-27L
27
left
4 602 029 01 00 027
E-F80-28L
28
left
4 602 029 01 00 028
E-F80-29L
29
left
4 602 029 01 00 029
E-F80-30L
30
left
4 602 029 01 00 030
E-F80-24R
24
right
4 602 029 02 00 024
E-F80-25R
25
right
4 602 029 02 00 025
E-F80-26R
26
right
4 602 029 02 00 026
E-F80-27R
27
right
4 602 029 02 00 027
E-F80-28R
28
right
4 602 029 02 00 028
E-F80-29R
29
right
4 602 029 02 00 029
E-F80-30R
30
right
4 602 029 02 00 030
Foot shell connection plate
Order No.
Description
Size
Article No.
E-F80-AP1
Connection plate, small
24-26
4 602 029 00 00 002
E-F80-AP2
Connection plate, big
27-30
4 602 029 00 00 003
24
1.2 Modular Adapters
Tube Clamp Adapters
10°
1.3 Functional Adapters
A1 Tube Clamp Adapter
2
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1
Weight limit
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A1-Al
Aluminium
69 g
4 113 011 30 11 000
1
A1-St
Steel
112 g
4 113 011 30 22 000
1
A1-Ti
Titanium
69 g
4 113 011 30 33 000
1
Steel
136 g
4 113 010 34 22 000
1
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
Titanium
83 g
4 113 030 30 33 000
2
1.5 Hip Joints
The A1 Tube Clamp Adapters have a visible measuring scale which facilitates the rotation adjustments when used with the A3 Tube Adapter.
Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
for Ø 30 mm tube
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No. A2-Ti
Weight limit
1.9 Valves
with 10° inclination for Ø 30 mm tube
25
1.10 Socket Accessories
A1-St34
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
for Ø 34 mm tube
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Tube Adapters
A3Tube Adapter
1
2
The tube adapters (aluminum, steel, titanium) have a visible length scale that helps measure for shortening the prosthesis and simplifies documentation.
Order No.
Weight limit
Version
Length
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A3-Al200
Aluminium
200 mm
160 g
4 113 051 30 11 200
1
A3-Al400
Aluminium
400 mm
270 g
4 113 051 30 11 400
1
A3-St200
Steel
200 mm
210 g
4 113 051 30 22 200
1
A3-St400
Steel
400 mm
320 g
4 113 051 30 22 400
1
A3-Ti200
Titanium
200 mm
170 g
4 113 051 30 33 200
1
A3-Ti400
Titanium
400 mm
280 g
4 113 051 30 33 400
1
A4-St200
Steel
200 mm
320 g
4 113 050 34 22 200
2
A4-St400
Steel
400 mm
480 g
4 113 050 34 22 400
2
A4-Ti400
Titanium
400 mm
435 g
4 113 050 34 33 400
2
for Ă&#x2DC; 30 mm tube
for Ă&#x2DC; 34 mm tube
26
1.3 Functional Adapters
1.2 Modular Adapters
Tube Adapter with pyramid
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
1
Order No.
Weight limit
Version
Length
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A5
< 136 kg
Aluminium
455 mm
320 g
4 620 010 00 00 000
1
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Ø 30 mm
Reduction Adapter 34/30 mm
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
for all Uniprox knee joints with 34 mm tube clamp (JT09, JT20/JT22, JT20S/JT22S)
2
Weight limit
A30
Version
Length
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
Aluminium
100 mm
91 g
4 610 07 000 00 008
2
Version
Length
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
Aluminium
400 mm
210 g
4 113 070 30 11 400
1
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
Prosthesis Tube
1
Ø 30 mm Tube Order No. R1-Al400
Weight limit
27
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Reduction of 34 mm tube clamp on 30 mm tube clamp
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Aadapters with lamination anchor, incl. lamination dummy
1
2
4
3
Order No.
Application
Version
A6-Al
Transtibial
A6-St
Weight limit
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
Aluminium
62 g
4 114 010 00 11 000
1
Transtibial
Steel
87 g
4 114 010 00 22 000
1
A6-St34
Transtibial
Steel
122 g
4 114 010 00 22 034
1
A6-Ti
Transtibial
Titanium
53 g
4 114 010 00 33 000
1
A7-Al
Transfemoral
Aluminium
80 g
4 114 080 00 44 000
2
A9-Ti
Transtibial*
Titanium
69 g
4 147 009 20 00 000
3
* for locking devices
Replacement Part for Socket Attachment Block Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-A02
Lamination dummy made of special rubber
4 114 019 01 00 000
4
Order No.
Application
Version
A8-Ti
Transtibial*
Titanium
* for locking devices 28
Weight limit
Weight
Article No.
66 g
4 147 019 19 00 000
1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Attachment Block
3
4
Order No.
Diameter of Wooden Block
Height
Weight limit
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A60-148
Ø 148 mm
64 mm
< 100 kg
320 g
4 114 060 00 77 148
1
A60-120
Ø 120 mm
64 mm
< 100 kg
280 g
4 114 060 00 77 120
2
A60-30
Ø 120 mm
30 mm
< 100 kg
160 g
4 114 060 00 77 030
3
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
2
1.3 Functional Adapters
with wood proximally, incl. lamination dummy and M6 countersunk screws
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Description
Article No.
E-A01
Lamination Dummy (plastic)*
4 114 069 01 00 000
4
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
* M6 countersunk screws included
29
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
Replacement Part for Socket Attachment Block
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Adapter with adjusting screws
1
Order No.
2
Weight limit
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A10-Al
Aluminium
45 g
4 114 020 00 11 000
1
A10-St
Steel
79 g
4 114 020 00 22 000
1
A10-Ti
Titanium
51 g
4 114 020 00 33 000
1
A11-St
Steel
123 g
4 114 030 00 22 000
2
A11-Ti
Titanium
79 g
4 114 030 00 33 000
2
Non-rotatable
Rotatable
30
1.3 Functional Adapters
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A13-Al
Aluminium
58 g
4 114 040 00 44 000
1
A13-St
Steel
94 g
4 114 040 00 22 000
1
A13-Ti
Titanium
51 g
4 114 040 00 33 000
1
A13
Titanium, flat attachment surface
50 g
4 114 040 03 33 000
1
A14-St
Steel
128 g
4 114 050 00 22 000
2
A14-Ti
Titanium
85 g
4 114 050 00 33 000
2
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Weight limit
1.5 Hip Joints
with Central Bore
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
with Central Bore and Rotatable
Accessories for Socket Adapters Description
Article No.
E-A03
Spacer for rotatable socket adapter
4 114 029 00 00 000
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No.
2
31
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Adapters with Pyramid
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Anchor Adapters with attached pyramid
Order No.
Type
A15-St
3-Arm with pyramid
Weight limit
Version
Weight
Article No.
Steel
110 g
4 114 100 01 22 000
Socket Anchor Adapters with rotating adjustment with inside thread M36x1.5 and attachment adapter
1
2
Order No.
Type
A17-St
A18-St
32
Weight limit
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
3-arm with adjusting screws
Steel
167g
4 114 070 99 22 000
1
3-arm with pyramid
Steel
135 g
4 114 070 77 22 000
2
1.2 Modular Adapters
Socket Adapters
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
3-arm
Steel
110 g
4 114 080 01 22 000
1
A20-St
4-arm, long
Steel
120 g
4 114 080 02 22 000
2
A21-St
4-arm, short
Steel
91 g
4 114 080 03 22 000
3
A86
knee disarticulation anchor
Steel
170 g
4 114 080 06 22 000
4
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
A19-St
Weight limit
1.5 Hip Joints
Type
4
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
3
Bending protection for A19, A20 and A21 Threaded Adapters
Description
Article No.
E-A04
Bending protection for thread: M36 x 1.5
4 114 110 00 00 000
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
with outside thread M36x1.5
33
1.10 Socket Accessories
2
1.3 Functional Adapters
with inside thread M36x1.5
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Threaded Adapters for A19, A20 and A21 with outside thread M36x1.5
1
Order No.
Weight limit
4
3
2
Version
Material
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A22-St
with pyramid
Steel
70 g
4 114 090 99 22 000
1
A22-Ti
with pyramid
Titanium
40 g
4 114 090 99 33 000
1
A23-St
with adjusting screws
Steel
78 g
4 114 090 77 22 000
2
A23-Ti
with adjusting screws
Titanium
51 g
4 114 090 77 33 000
2
A24-Al
30 mm tube
Aluminium
39 g
4 114 090 00 11 000
3
A25-Ti
Tube clamp 30 mm
Titanium
69 g
4 114 090 88 33 000
4
Accessories for Modular Adapters
1
Order No.
2
Description
3
Thread
Length in mm
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
Pict.
M28-12
hex socket head screw
M8
12
10
4 226 050 00 00 012
1
M28-16
hex socket head screw
M8
16
10
4 226 050 00 00 016
1
M33
Hexagon socket head cap screw, M8x25
M5
18
10
4 226 030 05 00 018
2
M6-16
Countersunk screw
M6
16
4
4 226 050 00 00 616
3
34
1.2 Modular Adapters
Attachment plates for laminated sockets
5
4
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
3
Transtibial (back side sandblasted) Type
Diameter
Thickness
Version
Weight limit Weight
A26-Al
Centered
64 mm
9 mm
Aluminum < 100 kg back side sandblasted
74 g
Article No.
Pict.
4 115 010 00 00 064 1 1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
Transfemoral Type
Diameter
Thickness
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A27-Al1
Centered
84 mm
6 mm
Aluminum
91 g
4 115 010 00 00 084
2
A27-Al2
8 mm posterior off-set
84 mm
6 mm
Aluminum
77 g
4 115 010 01 00 084
3
A27-Al3
12 mm posterior off-set
84 mm
6 mm
Aluminum
68 g
4 115 010 02 00 084
4
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-A05
Lamination dummy for attachment plates (incl. screws)
4 114 110 00 00 001
5
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
2
1.3 Functional Adapters
incl. screws and lamination dummy (Pict. 5)
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Lamination Attachment Plates 1.8 Stump Socks
Universal, for locking devices, with screws, without dummy
1.9 Valves
! Lamination dummy E-A05 (Pict.5) fitting (not included in delivery)
2
Order No.
Type
Dimensions
Height
Version
Weight limit
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A28-Al
round
Ă&#x2DC; 70 mm
8 mm
Aluminum
< 100 kg
55 g
4 147 009 21 00 000
1
A29-Al
square
52 x 52 mm
9 mm
Aluminum
< 100 kg
30 g
4 147 009 01 00 000
2 35
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Adapter Kit, with central thread Transfemoral
Order No.
Weight limit
A33-Ti
Version
Weight
Article No.
Titanium/Aluminium
110 g
4 115 030 01 00 000
Lamination and thermoforming shell for A33-Ti Order No.
Version
Article No.
A34-Al
Aluminium
4 115 030 01 00 001
Socket Attachment Set, for thermoformed sockets with screws
Asymmetrical Order No. Weight limit Version
Diameter outside
Aluminium Ø 85 mm
A31-Al
Diameter inside
Weight
Article No.
Ø 79 mm
139 g
4 115 020 01 00 000
Symmetrical Version
Diameter outside
Diameter inside
Height
Weight
Article No.
A35-Al1
Aluminium
Ø 100 mm
Ø 88 mm
25 mm
168 g
4 115 040 00 00 400
A35-Al2
Aluminium
Ø 90 mm
Ø 77 mm
20 mm
156 g
4 115 040 00 00 350
A35-Al3
Aluminium
Ø 78 mm
Ø 64 mm
20 mm
124 g
4 115 040 00 00 250
Order No.
36
Weight limit
1.2 Modular Adapters
Double Adapter
1.3 Functional Adapters
with Proximal and Distal Adjusting Screws
Weight limit
Length
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A37-Ti1
32 mm
Titanium
80 g
4 116 010 00 00 032
1
A37-Ti2
45 mm
Titanium
96 g
4 116 010 00 00 045
2
A37-Ti3
60 mm
Titanium
106 g
4 116 010 00 00 060
3
A37-Ti4
75 mm
Titanium
120 g
4 116 010 00 00 075
4
Order No.
4
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
3
1.5 Hip Joints
2
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Double Adapter
Installation Height
Version
Weight
Article No.
A38-St
19 mm
Steel
122 g
4 116 020 00 00 000
A39-Ti
16 mm
Titanium
77 g
4 116 020 01 00 000
1.9 Valves
Weight limit
37
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Double Pyramid Adapter
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Double Adapter Pyramid and Ă&#x2DC; 30 mm Clamp
Order No.
Weight limit
Height
Version
Weight
Article No.
45 mm
Titanium
76 g
4 116 030 88 00 045
Installation Height
Version
Weight
Article No.
A41-Ti1
27 mm
Titanium
83 g
4 116 030 77 00 032
A41-Ti2
40 mm
Titanium
98 g
4 116 030 77 00 045
A40-Ti1
Double Adapter with Pyramid and Adjusting Screws
Order No.
38
Weight limit
1.2 Modular Adapters
Shifting Adapter
Pict.
VA1-Ti
Tube clamp 30 mm/ pyramid
Titanium
130 g
4 117 010 99 00 000
1
VA2-Ti
Tube clamp 30 mm/ adjusting screws
Titanium
140 g
4 117 010 77 00 000
2
1.5 Hip Joints
Article No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Weight
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Version
1.8 Stump Socks
Art
1.9 Valves
Weight limit
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
2
39
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
A-P and M-L sliding adjustment of 10 mm
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Shifting Adapter with 12 mm adjustments in each direction with sliding cross, total height: 27 mm
Order No.
Weight limit
VA8-Al
Art
Version
Weight
Article No.
4-hole/4-hole
Aluminium/Titanium
179 g
4 117 030 00 00 000
Shifting Adapter with 25 mm adjustments in each direction (only for trial fittings) ! incl. 1 x 4 perforated plate with counter sunk and 1 x 4 perforated plate with thread inserts
Order No. VA9-Al
40
Weight limit
Art
Version
Weight
Article No.
4-hole/4-hole
Aluminium
283 g
4 117 060 00 00 000
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
2
4
3
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-VA01
Housing for shifting adapter with 6 cap screws M5x10
4 117 069 00 00 001
1
E-VA02
Sliding unit for shifting adapter (with central bore)
4 117 069 00 00 002
2
2 strips for shifting adapter with 6 countersunk screws M3x6
4 117 069 00 00 003
3
Sliding unit for shifting adapter (threaded)
4 117 069 00 00 004
4
1.5 Hip Joints
E-VA03 E-VA04
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1
1.2 Modular Adapters
Service Parts for VA9-AL Shifting Adapter
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
Multipurpose Joint Adapter
Type
Height
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pict.
A49-Ti1
Adjusting screws on both sides
80 mm
Titanium
300 g
4 118 040 01 00 000
1
A49-Ti2
Adjusting screws/ Tube clamp 30 mm
98 mm
Titanium
310 g
4 118 040 02 00 000
2
1.8 Stump Socks
Weight limit
1.9 Valves
Order No.
2
41
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Adjustable from 180°–120° in both directions, incl. Allen key
1 Prosthetics 1.2 Modular Adapters
42
1.2 Modular Adapters
TA-1 and TA-2 rotation adapters:
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.3 Functional Adapters
Greater flexibility for everyday activities.
1.3 Functional Adapters
Greater independence when performing everyday activities: This is what Uniprox TA-1 and TA-2 rotation adapters represent. They restore natural mobility to transfemoral amputees in everyday situations. The transtibial section can be moved laterally, making it possible to sit comfortably again for long periods. Everyday situations such as putting on and taking off shoes or clothing can be once again mastered effortlessly. The rotation adapters also make it easier to get into a car. When sitting in a vehicle the transtibial portion of the prosthesis can be swiveled laterally to relieve the groin.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
The release button is easy to use, it moves freely and it is operated by means of an easily reached plastic button. It can be adapted to match the contour of the cosmetic cover.
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
The TA-2 rotation adapter offers even more adjustment options with the M36 threaded connector.
43
1.10 Socket Accessories
The TA-1 rotation adapter can be assembled onto any 4-hole connector and it can rotate up to 5째 thanks to its elongated mounting hole. An additional socket adapter is not required.
1.5 Hip Joints
Overview of Technical Highlights:
1 Prosthetics 1.3 Functional Adapters
1
2
2
Order No.
Article No.
TA-1
4 162 010 00 00 000
TA-2
4 162 020 00 00 000
Technical Data: TA-1 and TA-2 Version
Weight
Pict.
approx. 5째 with the 4-hole connector
Titanium
220 g
1
approx. 30째 with the M-36 thread
Titanium
268 g
2
Total height
Additional Release height button length
Max. rotation
Rotation potential*
TA-1
27 mm
approx. 11 mm
min. 5 cm max. 8.5 cm
360째 without cosmetic cover
TA-2
36 mm
approx. 11 mm
min. 5 cm max. 8.5 cm
360째 without cosmetic cover
Max. patient weight
* with component assembly
TA-1 Rotation Adapter
8.5 cm 5 cm
additional height 11 mm Total height 27 mm
TA-2 Rotation Adapter 8.5 cm 5 cm additional height 11 mm Total height 36 mm
Replacement Parts for Rotation Adapters Order No.
Type
Article No.
E-TA01
Push button, black
4 162 019 00 00 000
E-TA02
Sliding releaser
4 162 019 00 00 001
44
Attachment with 4-hole Adapter
The modular monocentric locking knee joint for geriatrics without the adjustability of the swing phase is easy for geriatrics to manage. It is characterized by its light weight, which makes it very comfortable to wear. The posterior placement of the knee axis provides high stance-phase stability.
Description
Article No.
JT01
Modular Monocentric Locking Knee Joint for Geriatrics
4 124 000 00 00 000
Technical Data Installation height above the axis center of rotation
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Aluminum
35 mm
295 g
140째
pyramid
30 mm tube clamp
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.8 Stump Socks
Material
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-JT01-01
Knee cap
4 124 009 01 00 000
E-JT01-02
Holding device (O-ring)
4 124 009 02 00 000
E-JT01-03
Extension stop, delivery unit = 1 piece
4 124 009 09 00 000
E-JT01-04
Lock handle, complete
4 123 009 01 00 000
E-JT01-05
Cable clamp
4 124 009 11 00 000
E-JT01-06
Threaded fitting, short
4 124 009 12 00 000
1.9 Valves
Service Parts
45
1.10 Socket Accessories
Weight limit
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Alignment recommendation: traditional alignment.
1.2 Modular Adapters
JT01 Modular Monocentric Locking Knee Joint for Geriatrics
1.3 Functional Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT02 Modular Monocentric Knee Joint with Manual Lock and Extension Assist The modular monocentric knee joint is a locked joint design for prosthetics users who require high stability. The stance phase stability is secured by the knee lock. An integrated spring unit assists in the extension of the knee joint to the locked position. Alignment recommendation: traditional alignment.
Order No.
Description
Material
Article No.
JT02-St
Modular Monocentric Knee Joint
Steel
4 126 000 00 22 000
JT02-Ti
Modular Monocentric Knee Joint
Titanium
4 126 000 00 33 000
Technical Data Installation height above the axis center of rotation
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
JT02-St
37 mm
560 g
120째
pyramid
pyramid
JT02-Ti
37 mm
405 g
120째
pyramid
pyramid
Order No.
Weight limit
Service Parts Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-JT01-04
Lock handle, complete
4 123 009 01 00 000
E-JT01-05
Cable clamp
4 124 009 11 00 000
E-JT01-06
Threaded fitting, short
4 124 009 12 00 000
E-JT02-01
Knee cap
4 126 009 01 00 000
E-JT02-02
Spring guide housing
4 126 009 04 00 000
E-JT02-03
Spring
4 126 009 10 00 000
E-JT02-04
Cap screw, M4x8
4 126 009 12 00 000
46
1.2 Modular Adapters
JT03 Single-Axis Lightweight Knee Joint with Pyramid
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
This single - axis lightweight knee joint is recommended for geriatric patients requiring high stability. The locking pin engages audibly and can be easily released â&#x20AC;&#x201C; also while load bearing - due to its conical form. Its very light weight makes it comfortable.
Order No.
Description
Article No.
JT03
Lightweight knee joint with pyramid
4 127 000 00 00 000
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Alignment recommendation: traditional alignment.
Installation height above the axis center of rotation
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Titanium
37 mm
295 g
150°
pyramid
30 mm tube clamp
1.8 Stump Socks
Material
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-JT03-01
Axis bearing
4 127 009 01 00 000
E-JT03-02
Knee lock cable
4 127 009 03 00 000
E-JT03-03
Clamp liner for lock
4 127 009 05 00 000
E-JT03-04
Clamp screw
4 127 009 07 00 000
1.9 Valves
Service Parts
47
1.10 Socket Accessories
Weight limit
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Technical Data
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT05 Modular Monocentric Safety Knee Joint This modular safety knee joint is recommended for patients requiring high stability but able to walk without a locked knee joint. The weight-activated locking mechanism provides stability in the stance phase and a spring unit assists in the extension. It is also very light, which makes it very comfortable. Alignment recommendation: traditional alignment.
Note the correct placement of the extension assist cable of the JT05 when assembling the prosthesis.
Order No.
Description
Article No.
JT05-St
Modular Monocentric Safety Knee Joint, Steel
4 130 010 00 22 000
JT05-Ti
Modular Safety Knee Joint, Titanium
4 130 010 00 33 000
Technical Data Installation height above the axis center of rotation
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
JT05-St
40 mm
530 g
150째
pyramid
pyramid
JT05-Ti
40 mm
355 g
150째
pyramid
pyramid
Order No.
48
Weight limit
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Article No.
Brake bushing
4 130 009 01 00 000
E-JT05-02
Bushing safety device
4 130 009 02 00 000
E-JT05-03
Axis screw
4 130 009 03 00 000
E-JT05-04
Extension stop, inferior
4 130 009 04 00 000
E-JT05-05
Rubber bumper
4 130 009 05 00 000
E-JT05-06
Brass washer, small, 2 pieces
4 130 009 06 00 000
E-JT05-07
Swing axis holding device
4 130 009 07 00 000
E-JT05-08
Swing axis
4 130 009 08 00 000
E-JT05-09
Brass washer, small, 2 pieces
4 130 009 09 00 000
E-JT05-10
Extension stop, superior
4 130 009 10 00 000
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Description
E-JT05-01
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
Service Parts
2
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
3 1
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-JT05-11
Extension assist set for JT05
4 130 010 00 00 001
1
4 130 019 05 00 001
2
E-JT05-17
Centering ring
4 130 009 12 00 001
3
E-JT05-13
Spring
4 130 019 02 00 001
no pict.
1.9 Valves
Extension assist cable, length: 304 mm
49
1.10 Socket Accessories
E-JT05-16
1.8 Stump Socks
Service Parts for Extension Assist for JT05 Knee Joint
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT09 Safety Knee Joint. Resilient and save. The JT09 is a monocentric safety knee joint for mobility levels 1 and 2, in other words for patients who require high stability. The joint is designed for a load of up to 150 kilograms, which is composed of the bearing load plus the weight of the body. The JT09 is equipped with a very sturdy, wear-resistant winder brake. The spring extension assist is integrated into the joint, which helps when fitting a cosmetic cover. Another great feature of this joint: the spring extension assist can be adjusted externally using an adjusting ring. The prosthetist can use this ring to set the swing phase easily without any tools.
Overview of Technical Highlights: • Monocentric Safety Knee Joint • High stance-phase stability • Weights up to 150 kg • Easy to adjust the swingphase control
50
1.2 Modular Adapters
JT09 Safety Knee Joint.
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
28 mm
890 g
145째
Pyramid adapter
34 mm tube clamp
Order No.
Description
Article No.
JT09
JT09 Safety Knee Joint
4 176 010 01 00 000
Please order tube adapter A4-Ti400 separately.
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
Setting the integrated spring extension assist (can be done externally without tools)
51
1.10 Socket Accessories
Setting the stance-phase stability
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
!
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Installation Height
1.3 Functional Adapters
Technical Data Weight limit
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT20 Polycentric Knee Joint. Easy to switch from a stable geometry to a dynamic geometry. The technology behind this is two pole curves that can easily be adjusted by simply turning the extender wheel. On „S“, the knee joint is set for high stability. On this setting, the center of rotation is still in the stable range. On the „D“ setting the JT20 allows for a more dynamic gait. The center of rotation falls more in the dynamic range. Depending on the prosthesis wearer‘s condition, he or she can use the polycentric JT20 for the majority of the rehabilitation process. High stability is a top priority at the start of rehab and then when the prosthesis wearer gets more mobile, a prosthetist can quickly and easily adjust the joint for a more dynamic gait. A mechanical spring extension assist and a pneumatic shock absorber—so called final extension stop shock absorption—are included on the JT20. The two components work together to produce a harmonious gait pattern. With a weight limit of 150 kilograms and a design for mobility levels 2 and 3, the knee joint can be used by a wide range of patients.
Overview of Technical Highlights: • Pneumatic final extension stop shock absorption • Flexion and extension set separately • Geometrically stable joint • Two pole curves (stable or dynamic)
All that is needed to switch from a stable geometry to a dynamic one is a simple twist of the extender wheel: „S“stands for high stance-phase stability „D“ is for a more dynamic gait. 52
1.2 Modular Adapters
JT20 Polycentric Knee Joint.
Weight limit Installation Height
Weight
Flexion angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
15 mm
790 g
135째
Pyramid adapter
34 mm tube clamp
JT20-M36
10 mm
790 g
135째
M-36 adapter
34 mm tube clamp
2
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
JT20-PYR
JT20 with pyramid
4 170 010 01 00 000
1
JT20-M36
JT20 with M36 adapter
4 170 010 02 00 000
2
Please order tube adapter A4-Ti400 separately.
Service parts JT20 Version
Weight
Article No.
Pyramid adapter for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 001
E-JT20-02
M36 thread for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 002
A86
Knee disarticulation anchor
Steel
170 g
4 114 080 05 22 000
A30
Reduction Adapter 34/30 mm
Aluminium
91 g
4 610 070 00 00 008
Order No.
Description
E-JT20-01
Weight limit
53
1.10 Socket Accessories
Pole curve progression red: stable green: dynamic
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
!
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT20-PYR
1.3 Functional Adapters
Technical Data Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT22 Polycentric Knee Joint with Pneumatic Swing Phase Control. Pneumatic swing phase control with a seperate adjustment of flexion and extension. With a weight limit of 150 kilograms and a design for mobility levels 3. The technology behind this is two pole curves that can easily be adjusted by simply turning the extender wheel. On „S“, the knee joint is set for high stability. On this setting, the center of rotation is still in the stable range. On the „D“ setting the JT22 allows for a more dynamic gait. The center of rotation falls more in the dynamic range. Depending on the prosthesis wearer‘s condition, he or she can use the polycentric JT22 for the majority of the rehabilitation process. High stability is a top priority at the start of rehab and then when the prosthesis wearer gets more mobile, a prosthetist can quickly and easily adjust the joint for a more dynamic gait.
54
1.2 Modular Adapters
JT22: Polycentric Knee Joint with Pneumatic Swing Phase Control
Fitting hight
Part weight
Flexing angle Proximal connection
Distal connection
JT22-PYR
15 mm
820 g
135 degs
pyramid adapter
34 mm tube clamp
JT22-M36
10 mm
820 g
135 degs
M36 thread
34 mm tube clamp
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Weight limit
1.3 Functional Adapters
Technical Specifications: Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
All that is needed to switch from a stable geometry to a dynamic one is a simple twist of the extender wheel: „S“stands for high stance-phase stability
Article No.
JT22-PYR
34 mm tube clamp
4 170 010 11 00 000
JT22-M36
34 mm tube clamp
4 170 010 12 00 000
Version
Weight
Article No.
Pyramid adapter for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 001
E-JT20-02
M36 thread for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 002
A86
Knee disarticulation anchor
Steel
170 g
4 114 080 05 22 000
A30
Reduction Adapter 34/30 mm
Aluminium
91 g
4 610 070 00 00 008
Order No.
Description
E-JT20-01
Weight limit
55
1.10 Socket Accessories
Service parts JT22
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Distal connection
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
„D“ is for a more dynamic gait.
Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT20S/JT22S Polycentric Knee Joints with flexible stance control. In polycentric knee joints the placement of the axes (axis geometry), as well as the structure and the associated transferral of vertical forces, is critical to the stability of the joint. Thanks to its adjustable flexible posture control and the adjustable axis geometry, the JT22S offers two important options for adjusting joint stability to the individual needs of the patient. The adjustable flexible posture control offers the user the option of primary bending of up to 5° without causing flexion, which significantly increases stability particularly when going downhill. In addition, stability can be increased (S=stable) or reduced (D=dynamic) using the adjustable axis geometry. The function of the JT22S is rounded off by pneumatic swing phase monitoring, in which flexion and extension can be set separately from one another.
JT20S JT22S
Technical Specifications • Infinitely adjustable flexible stance control for more stabilitity • Adjustable flexion and extension control • Improved gait pattern by pneumatic swing phase control (JT22S) • Pneumatic extension stop • Weight limit 150 kg • Walking speed max. 5 km/h • Optional connection of proximal (pyramid or M36 thread)
56
JT20S/JT22S Technical Specifications: Part weight
Flexing angle
Proximal connection
Distal connection
JT20S-PYR
15 mm
790 g
135 degs
pyramid adapter
34 mm tube clamp
JT20S-M36
10 mm
790 g
135 degs
M36 thread
34 mm tube clamp
JT22S-PYR
15 mm
820 g
135 degs
pyramid adapter
34 mm tube clamp
JT22S-M36
10 mm
820 g
135 degs
M36 thread
34 mm tube clamp
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.3 Functional Adapters
Fitting hight
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Weight limit
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Article No.
Pict.
JT20S-PYR
JT20S with pyramid
4 170 010 01 10 000
1
JT20S-M36
JT20S with M36 adapter
4 170 010 02 10 000
2
JT22S-PYR
JT22S with pyramid
4 170 010 11 10 000
1
JT22S-M36
JT22S with M36 adapter
4 170 010 12 10 000
2
Please order tube adapter A4-Ti400 separately.
1.8 Stump Socks
!
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Description
Pole curve progression red: stable green: dynamic
Service parts JT20S/JT22S Version
Weight
Article No.
Pyramid adapter for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 001
E-JT20-02
M36 thread for JT20S/JT22S
Steel
80 g
4 170 001 00 22 002
A86
Knee disarticulation anchor
Steel
170 g
4 114 080 05 22 000
A30
Reduction Adapter 34/30 mm
Aluminium
91 g
4 610 070 00 00 008
Order No.
Description
E-JT20-01
Weight limit
57
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
2
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1 Prosthetics 1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
JT31 Monocentric Knee-Joint with Aluminum frame and SNS-Hydraulic The JT31 is a very light-weight knee joint for active patients. The light-weight Aluminum frame with SNS-Hydraulic provides a very high stability to the patient. Individually adjustable swing- and standphase. Bicycle- or Locking mode can be activated by a switch-lever.
PROS T H E T IC
Alignment K N E Erecommendation: S TKA (trochanter, knee, ankle) < 114 kg
Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit
• Replacement knee caps • Durable construction • Various applications
• Hydraulic screw Nyliner set
Model #
Description
41740
Nyliner Kit
Order No.
Description
Material
JT31
Monocentric Knee-Joint with SNS-Hydraulic
Aluminum
Model #
POrder R ONo.S T H E T I22285 C K N E Black E SMax < 114 kg
JT31
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max® 4-Hole, Black Black Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian Black Max® Pyramid, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian Black Max® Short, Black Heel Height Weight
Technical Data JT31
Flexion angle
Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
10087
®
234 mm
4 610 010 00 00 000
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Description
21639 21641 21660 21649 Weight22287 limit
Artuicle No.
747 g
150°
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Model #
Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Pyramid
4-hole
Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket Attachment Plate Kit Replacement knee caps • Hydraulic screw Nyliner set igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings • Includes
• Adapter with Pyramid 4-hole
• Durable construction • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern • Various applications Accepts M8 Order No. Weight• limit Material Weight Article No. Titanium
< 136 kg
A70
71 g
4 620 030 00#00 000 Model 41740
Knee-Ex-Adapter Model # 21639
Order No. 21641 A71
Model #
Weight Limit
10237 Description
100 kg (220 lb)
Black Max 4-Hole, Black
Model # Description Black Max® Service Tool Kit SBMKIT-SHORT
Article No. and reinserting bearing assemblies
® Black Black MaxMax Pyramid, Black Knee Platform Assembly
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
22287
4 620 020 00 00 000 ® •Black Knee platform to assist in the assembly of the Black Max Max Short, Black
22285 10087
Black Max® Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
Model #
1 • Includes Nyliners, needle bearings, bearing carriers, washers, through shaft and screws Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
21660 21649
®
Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian
Spare Part-Set JT31
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket OrderAttachment No. Description Article No. Plate Kit Press for bushings E-JT31-STK • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern E-JT31-TS • Accepts M8 Accessories-Set for JT31-JT34 E-JT31-HS 58
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting
®
WeightBlack limit Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian
Description Nyliner Kit
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
4 610 019 00 30 000
SNS-Hydraulic for JT31-JT34 4 610 019 00 32 000 Model # Weight Limit Product Weight 10054
100 kg (220 lb)
Pict.
• Includes igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings 4 610 019 00 28 000 1
359 g
2 w. Pict.
2 Model #
Description
SBMKIT-STAND
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.2 Modular Adapters
JT32 Monocentric Knee-Joint with Aluminum frame and SNS-Hydraulic
1.3 Functional Adapters
The JT32 is a very light-weight knee joint for active patients. The light-weight Aluminum frame with SNS hydraulic provides a very high stability to the patient. Individually adjustable swing- and standphase. Bicycle- or Locking mode can be activated by a switch-lever.
PROS T H E T IC
Alignment K N E Erecommendation: S TKA (trochanter, knee, ankle)
Nyliner Kit
• Replacement knee caps • Durable construction • Various applications
• Hydraulic screw Nyliner set
Model #
Description
41740
Nyliner Kit
Order No.
Description
Material
JT32
Monocentric Knee-Joint with SNS-Hydraulic
Aluminum
Description
21639 21641 21660 21649 Weight22287 limit
POrder R ONo.S T H E T I22285 C K N E Black E SMax < 114 kg
JT32
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max® 4-Hole, Black Black Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian Black Max® Pyramid, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian Black Max® Short, Black Heel Height Weight
Technical Data JT32
Flexion angle
Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
10087
®
236 mm
4 610 020 00 00 000
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
660 g
150°
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Model #
Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
4-hole
4-hole
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Model #
Artuicle No.
1.5 Hip Joints
Knee Caps
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
< 114 kg
Nyliner Kit Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket Attachment Plate Kit Replacement knee caps • Hydraulic screw Nyliner set igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings • Includes
• Adapter with Pyramid 4-hole
• Durable construction • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern • Various applications Accepts M8 Order No. Weight• limit Material Weight Article No. 71 g
4 620 030 00#00 000 Model 41740
Knee-Ex-Adapter Model # 21639
Order No. 21641
Weight Limit 100 kg (220 lb)
Black Max 4-Hole, Black
Model # Description Black Max® Service Tool Kit SBMKIT-SHORT
WeightBlack limit Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting
®
Article No. and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
22287
4 620 020 00 00 000 ® •Black Knee platform to assist in the assembly of the Black Max Max Short, Black
22285 10087
Black Max® Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
Model #
1 • Includes Nyliners, needle bearings, bearing carriers, washers, through shaft and screws Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
®
Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian
Spare Part-Set JT32
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket OrderAttachment No. Description Article No. Plate Kit Press for bushings E-JT31-STK • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern E-JT31-TS • Accepts M8 Accessories-Set for JT31-JT34 E-JT31-HS
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
100 kg (220 lb)
Pict.
• Includes igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings 4 610 019 00 28 000 1 4 610 019 00 30 000
SNS-Hydraulic for JT31-JT34 4 610 019 00 32 000 Model # Weight Limit Product Weight 10054
1.9 Valves
® Black Black MaxMax Pyramid, Black Knee Platform Assembly
21660 21649
359 g
2 w. Pict.
2 Model #
Description
SBMKIT-STAND
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard 59
1.10 Socket Accessories
A71
Model # 10237 Description
Description Nyliner Kit
1.8 Stump Socks
Titanium
< 136 kg
A70
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Knee Caps
JT33 Monocentric Knee-Joint with Titanium frame and SNS-Hydraulic The JT33 is a very light-weight knee joint for active patients. The light-weight Titanium frame with SNS hydraulic provides a very high stability to the patient. Individually adjustable swing- and standphase. Bicycle- or Locking mode can be activated by a switch-lever.
PROS T H E T IC
Alignment K N E Erecommendation: S TKA (trochanter, knee, ankle) < 136 kg
Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit
• Replacement knee caps • Durable construction • Various applications
• Hydraulic screw Nyliner set
Model #
Description
41740
Nyliner Kit
Order No.
Description
Material
JT33
Monocentric Knee-Joint with SNS-Hydraulic
Titanium
Model #
POrder R ONo.S T H E T I22285 C K N E Black E SMax < 136 kg
JT33
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max® 4-Hole, Black Black Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian Black Max® Pyramid, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian Black Max® Short, Black Heel Height Weight
Technical Data JT33
Flexion angle
Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
10087
®
234 mm
4 610 030 00 00 000
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Description
21639 21641 21660 21649 Weight22287 limit
Artuicle No.
660 g
150°
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Model #
Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Pyramid
4-hole
Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket Attachment Plate Kit Replacement knee caps • Hydraulic screw Nyliner set igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings • Includes
• Adapter with Pyramid 4-hole
• Durable construction • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern • Various applications Accepts M8 Order No. Weight• limit Material Weight Article No. Titanium
< 136 kg
A70
71 g
4 620 030 00#00 000 Model 41740
Knee-Ex-Adapter Model # 21639
Order No. 21641 A71
21660 21649 22287 22285 10087
Model #
Weight Limit
10237 Description
100 kg (220 lb)
Black Max 4-Hole, Black
Model # Description Black Max® Service Tool Kit SBMKIT-SHORT
Article No. and reinserting bearing assemblies
® Black Black MaxMax Pyramid, Black Knee Platform Assembly ®
Black Max® Short, Caucasian
Model #
Mark V, Caucasian
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket OrderAttachment No. Description Article No. Plate Kit Press for bushings E-JT31-STK • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern E-JT31-TS • Accepts M8 Accessories-Set for JT31-JT34
60
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
1 • Includes Nyliners, needle bearings, bearing carriers, washers, through shaft and screws Description
4 620 020 00 00 000 ® •Black Knee platform to assist in the assembly of the Black Max Max Short, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian
Spare Part-Set JT33
E-JT31-HS
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting
®
WeightBlack limit Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian
Description Nyliner Kit
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
4 610 019 00 30 000
SNS-Hydraulic for JT31-JT34 4 610 019 00 32 000 Model # Weight Limit Product Weight 10054
100 kg (220 lb)
Pict.
• Includes igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings 4 610 019 00 28 000 1
359 g
2 w. Pict.
2 Model #
Description
SBMKIT-STAND
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.2 Modular Adapters
JT34 Monocentric Knee-Joint with Titanium frame and SNS-Hydraulic
1.3 Functional Adapters
The JT34 is a very light-weight knee joint for active patients. The light-weight Titanium frame with SNS hydraulic provides a very high stability to the patient. Individually adjustable swing- and standphase. Bicycle- or Locking mode can be activated by a switch-lever.
PROS T H E T IC
Alignment K N E Erecommendation: S TKA (trochanter, knee, ankle)
Nyliner Kit
• Replacement knee caps • Durable construction • Various applications
• Hydraulic screw Nyliner set
Model #
Description
41740
Nyliner Kit
Order No.
Description
Material
JT34
Monocentric Knee-Joint with SNS-Hydraulic
Titanium
Description
21639 21641 21660 21649 Weight22287 limit
POrder R ONo.S T H E T I22285 C K N E Black E SMax < 136 kg
JT34
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max® 4-Hole, Black Black Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian Black Max® Pyramid, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian Black Max® Short, Black Heel Height Weight
Technical Data JT34
Flexion angle
Short, Caucasian Mark V, Caucasian
10087
®
236 mm
4 610 040 00 00 000
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
821 g
150°
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Model #
Description
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
4-hole
4-hole
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Model #
Artuicle No.
1.5 Hip Joints
Knee Caps
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
< 136 kg
Nyliner Kit Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket Attachment Plate Kit Replacement knee caps • Hydraulic screw Nyliner set igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings • Includes
• Adapter with Pyramid 4-hole
• Durable construction • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern • Various applications Accepts M8 Order No. Weight• limit Material Weight Article No. 71 g
4 620 030 00#00 000 Model 41740
A71
21660 21649 22287 22285 10087
Weight Limit 100 kg (220 lb)
Black Max 4-Hole, Black
Model # Description Black Max® Service Tool Kit SBMKIT-SHORT
WeightBlack limit Max® 4-Hole, Caucasian
Article No. and reinserting bearing assemblies
® Black Black MaxMax Pyramid, Black Knee Platform Assembly ®
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard
Black Max® Short, Caucasian
Model #
1 • Includes Nyliners, needle bearings, bearing carriers, washers, through shaft and screws Description
Mark V, Caucasian
BM-STK
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
4 620 020 00 00 000 ® •Black Knee platform to assist in the assembly of the Black Max Max Short, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian
Spare Part-Set JT34
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket OrderAttachment No. Description Article No. Plate Kit Press for bushings E-JT31-STK • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern E-JT31-TS • Accepts M8 Accessories-Set for JT31-JT34 E-JT31-HS
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
• Screw-drive mechanism for extracting
®
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
100 kg (220 lb)
Pict.
• Includes igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings 4 610 019 00 28 000 1 4 610 019 00 30 000
SNS-Hydraulic for JT31-JT34 4 610 019 00 32 000 Model # Weight Limit Product Weight 10054
1.9 Valves
21639
Order No. 21641
Model # 10237 Description
359 g
2 w. Pict.
2 Model #
Description
SBMKIT-STAND
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Standard 61
1.10 Socket Accessories
Knee-Ex-Adapter Model #
Description Nyliner Kit
1.8 Stump Socks
Titanium
< 136 kg
A70
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Knee Caps
JT35 Monocentric Knee-Joint with Titanium frame and SNS-Hydraulic (short) The JT35 is a very light-weight knee joint for active patients. The light-weight Titanium frame with SNS hydraulic provides a very high stability to the patient. Individually adjustable swing- and standphase. Bicycle- or Locking mode can be activated by a switch-lever. Alignment recommendation: TKA (trochanter, knee, ankle) < 136 kg
Order No. JT35
Description
P R O SMonocentric T H EKnee-Joint T I C withKSNS-Hydraulic N EES
Material
Artuicle No.
Titanium
4 610 050 00 00 000
Technical Data JT35 Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit
Heel Height POrder R ONo.S T H• Weight EReplacement T Ilimit C knee K Ncaps EES • Durable construction kg applications206 mm •< 136 Various
JT35
Weight
Flexion angle Proximal connection • Hydraulic screw Nyliner set
Distal connection
813 g
150°
4-hole
Knee Caps
Nyliner Kit
• Durable construction • Various applications
Weight limit Model #
< 136 kg
A70
21639 21641 21660 21649
21639
A71
Weight
Article No.
Black Max® Service Tool Kit
Description Titanium ®
71 g 4 620 030 00#00 000 Model • Black Max 4-Hole, Black 41740 ® Black Max 4-Hole, Caucasian Black Max® Pyramid, Black Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian
21660
Black Max® Pyramid, Black
21649 22287
Black Max® Pyramid, Caucasian Black Max® Short, Black Black Max® Short, Caucasian
22285 10087
Description Nyliner Kit
Description
Screw-drive mechanism for extracting Nyliner Kit and reinserting bearing assemblies
Black Max Service Tool Kit Black Max® Short, Black ® 22285 Black Max Short, Caucasian Model # for extracting Description • Screw-drive mechanism Black Max® 4-Hole, Black 10087 Black Mark Caucasian V, Caucasian Weight limit Article No. and reinserting BM-STK bearing assemblies Black Max® Service Tool Kit Max® 4-Hole,
22287 Knee-Ex-Adapter Model # Description
Order No. 21641
Material
Model #
• Hydraulic screw41740 Nyliner set
• Replacement 4-hole Adapter knee withcaps Pyramid
Order No.
4-hole
®
1
4 620 020 00 00 000
Black Max Knee Bearing Kit, Short
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket Model # Attachment Plate Kit Mark V, Caucasian BM-STK
®
Description
® Black Maxigus Service Tool Kit • Includes polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings
• Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern
Spare Part-Set JT35 • Accepts M8
Knee Disarticulation Rotatable Socket OrderAttachment No. Description Article No. Plate Kit Press for bushings E-JT31-STK • Uses standard 2” bolt circle or 4-bolt pattern E-JT31-TK • Accepts M8 Accessories-Set for JT35 E-JT31-HK 62
SNS-Hydraulic for JT35 Model # Weight Limit 10237 100 kg (220 lb)
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short Pict.
• Includes igus polymer bearings, washers and retaining rings 4 610 019 00 28 000 1 4 610 019 00 29 000
2
4 610 019 00 31 000
w. Pict.
2
Model #
Description
SBMKIT-SHORT
Black Max® Knee Bearing Kit, Short
1.2 Modular Adapters
H2 Modular Hip Joint
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.5 Hip Joints
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
The H2 aluminum modular hip joint is designed for hip disarticulation or hemipelvectomy patients with low activity. The construction design provides high stance phase stability and slight swing phase control.
Material
Weight
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Aluminum
790 g
Lamination plate
30 mm tube
Order No.
Description
Article No.
H2
Modular Hip Joint
4 139 000 00 00 000
Description
Article No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Weight limit
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Technical Data
Distal slide control anchor
4 139 009 01 00 000
Proximal slide control anchor
4 139 009 02 00 000
E-H2-03
Bumper
4 139 009 03 00 000
E-H2-04
Extension stop bumper
4 139 009 04 00 000
E-H2-05
Hip extension assist, latex, 10 mm
4 139 009 05 00 000
E-H2-06
Hip extension assist, latex, 8 mm
4 139 009 06 00 000
1.9 Valves
E-H2-01 E-H2-02
63
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.8 Stump Socks
Service Parts
1 Prosthetics 1.5 Hip Joints
H3 Modular Hip Joint
Technical Data Weight limit
Material
Weight
Proximal connection
Distal connection
Aluminum/Titanium/Steel
875 g
Lamination plate
30 mm tube
Order No.
Description
Article No.
H3
Modular Hip Joint
4 141 000 00 00 000
You can find tube clamp adapters that fit with the H3 modular hip joint in the Modular Adapters category.
Service Parts Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-H3-01
Lamination plate, inclination 120째
4 141 009 01 00 000
1
E-H3-02
Slide control spring (hip extension assist)
4 141 009 02 00 000
2
E-H3-03
Guide sleeve
4 141 009 03 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-04
Adjusting nut
4 141 009 04 00 000
3
E-H3-05
Steel tappet
4 141 009 05 00 000
4
E-H3-06
Bronze tappet
4 141 009 06 00 000
4
E-H3-07
Guide pin
4 141 009 07 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-08
Adjusting screw
4 141 009 08 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-09
Safety plate
4 141 009 09 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-11
Extension stop bumper
4 141 009 11 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-12
Hexagon socket head cap screw, M8x25
4 141 009 12 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-13
Hexagon socket head cap screw, M5x30
4 141 009 13 00 000
no pict.
E-H3-14
Lamination plate, inclination 130째
4 141 009 15 00 000
no pict.
64
1
4
2 3
1.2 Modular Adapters
Silicone Liners with Locking Mechanism
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.3 Functional Adapters
The silicone liners provide optimal suspension of the prosthesis on the residual limb. The liner is a distally closed interface made of an elastic silicone material. Suspension is obtained through a pin which is inserted in a locking device placed distally within the socket. The pin can be unlocked to loosen the liner and doff the prosthesis. Supracondylar suspension is not required when the liner/pin technique is used. Therefore, the socket can be trimmed down to allow easy donning of the prosthesis.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
This prosthetic design improves the patientâ&#x20AC;&#x2DC;s feedback and gives a safe feeling during ambulation.
Liner as Interface
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Additionally, liners can be used only as an interface without the suspension feature. These liners do not have a distal attachment. These silicone interfaces have a thickness between 1.5 mm and 6 mm. Thicker liners can be made of a silcone gel or a fluid-like polyurethane to achieve an even distribution of pressure over the residual limb.
65
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Through this technique the patients feel comfortable, specially those with bony, scarry other extremely sensitive residual limbs.
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Distal-Cup • Distal thickness: 6 mm, thins out proximally • Length: 150 mm • Distal volume compensation for conically shaped residual limbs • Soft padding for bony and scarred distal ends • Soft silicone • Shock absorbing • Transparent
Order No. Distal circumference in cm L01-06
6
Size Article No. Silicone Liner
Order No. Distal circumference in cm
Size Silicone Liner
Article No.
14
4 143 070 00 00 060
L01-16
16
25
4 143 070 00 00 160
L01-07
7
16
4 143 070 00 00 070
L01-17
17
26,5
4 143 070 00 00 170
L01-09
9
18
4 143 070 00 00 090
L01-19
19
28
4 143 070 00 00 190
L01-11
11
20/21
4 143 070 00 00 110
L01-20
20
30
4 143 070 00 00 200
L01-12
12
22
4 143 070 00 00 120
L01-22
22
32
4 143 070 00 00 220
L01-14
14
23,5
4 143 070 00 00 140
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
66
1.2 Modular Adapters
Silicone Liner, transparent (standard)
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
L20-20
20
4 143 010 00 00 200
L03-16
16
4 143 010 10 00 160
L20-21
21
4 143 010 00 00 210
L03-18
18
4 143 010 10 00 180
L20-22
22
4 143 010 00 00 220
L03-20
20
4 143 010 10 00 200
L20-23.5
23,5
4 143 010 00 00 235
L03-21
21
4 143 010 10 00 210
L20-25
25
4 143 010 00 00 250
L03-22
22
4 143 010 10 00 220
L20-26.5
26,5
4 143 010 00 00 265
L03-23.5
23,5
4 143 010 10 00 235
L20-28
28
4 143 010 00 00 280
L03-25
25
4 143 010 10 00 250
L20-30
30
4 143 010 00 00 300
L03-26.5
26,5
4 143 010 10 00 265
L20-32
32
4 143 010 00 00 320
L03-28
28
4 143 010 10 00 280
L20-34
34
4 143 010 00 00 340
L03-30
30
4 143 010 10 00 300
L20-36
36
4 143 010 00 00 360
L03-32
32
4 143 010 10 00 320
L20-38
38
4 143 010 00 00 380
L03-34
34
4 143 010 10 00 340
L20-40
40
4 143 010 00 00 400
L03-36
36
4 143 010 10 00 360
L20-42
42
4 143 010 00 00 420
L03-38
38
4 143 010 10 00 380
L20-45
45
4 143 010 00 00 450
L03-40
40
4 143 010 10 00 400
L03-42
42
4 143 010 10 00 420
L03-45
45
4 143 010 10 00 450
1.5 Hip Joints
Circumference in cm
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
reinforcement and distal connector
1.8 Stump Socks
connector and inner reinforcement
1.9 Valves
Silicone Liner with 10 cm inner
67
1.10 Socket Accessories
Silicone Liner without distal
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
• Wall thickness: 2.5 mm • Length: 350 mm • With and without distal connector • Standard liner for residual limbs with healthy soft tissue • Also for immediate postoperative fittings • Reduced shear and friction in the socket • Absorbs shocks and distributes pressure spots around the prosthesis • NEW: Including Liner stand
The circumference is measured 4 cm above distal end of the stump.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Uniprox SoftSkin-Liner
Standard 3 mm
Uniprox Prosthetics is setting new standards in silicone liner technology with the development of the SoftSkin generation. The innovative textile protects the liner and provides stability at the distal end of the residual limb. The proximal area is characterized by its optimum transverse elasticity. The fabric‘s sliding properties simplify handling, especially for geriatric patients. The combination of a high-quality silicone and a very sturdy textile result in a very durable liner even under extreme conditions. The SoftSkin Silicone Liner is available in a wall thickness of 3 mm and with shore hardness of 40 or 50.
SoftSkin S40 The comfortable liner. • • • • • • • • • • • •
Shore hardness: 40 Wall thickness: 3 mm Length: 350 mm Good gripping effect of the silicone Soft padding Newly developed textile gives a good hold at the distal end (inner matrix not required) Textile covering facilitates rolling Comfortable and easy to handle For patients with mobility levels 1–3 With distal connector Stainless steel pin fitting NEW: Including Liner stand
Order No.
Distal circumference in cm Article No.
Order No.
Distal circumference in cm Article No.
S40-16
16
4 164 010 40 00 160
S40-30
30
4 164 010 40 00 300
S40-18
18
4 164 010 40 00 180
S40-32
32
4 164 010 40 00 320
S40-20
20
4 164 010 40 00 200
S40-34
34
4 164 010 40 00 340
S40-21
21
4 164 010 40 00 210
S40-36
36
4 164 010 40 00 360
S40-22
22
4 164 010 40 00 220
S40-38
38
4 164 010 40 00 380
S40-23.5
23,5
4 164 010 40 00 235
S40-40
40
4 164 010 40 00 400
S40-25
25
4 164 010 40 00 250
S40-42
42
4 164 010 40 00 420
S40-26.5
26,5
4 164 010 40 00 265
S40-45
45
4 164 010 40 00 450
S40-28
28
4 164 010 40 00 280
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
68
1.2 Modular Adapters
SoftSkin S50 The active liner.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
S50-16
16
4 164 010 50 00 160
S50-30
30
4 164 010 50 00 300
S50-18
18
4 164 010 50 00 180
S50-32
32
4 164 010 50 00 320
S50-20
20
4 164 010 50 00 200
S50-34
34
4 164 010 50 00 340
S50-21
21
4 164 010 50 00 210
S50-36
36
4 164 010 50 00 360
S50-22
22
4 164 010 50 00 220
S50-38
38
4 164 010 50 00 380
S50-23.5
23,5
4 164 010 50 00 235
S50-40
40
4 164 010 50 00 400
S50-25
25
4 164 010 50 00 250
S50-42
42
4 164 010 50 00 420
S50-26.5
26,5
4 164 010 50 00 265
S50-45
45
4 164 010 50 00 450
S50-28
28
4 164 010 50 00 280
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints 1.5 Hip Joints
Article No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Circumference in cm
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
Shore hardness: 50 Wall thickness: 3 mm Length: 370 mm Hard silicone stabilizes the soft tissue Newly developed textile gives a good hold at the distal end (inner matrix not required) Combination of firm silicone and textile provides optimal control longer Textile covering facilitates rolling For patients with mobility levels 2–4 With distal connector Stainless steel pin fitting NEW: Including Liner stand
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
69
1.10 Socket Accessories
• • • • • • • • • • •
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices The S40CL/S50CL liner is used in a vacuum system. The liner cushions the residual limb‘s prominent bony areas and sensitive skin and its elastic properties make total contact with the stump possible. The liner also protects the skin and it can protect the skin and scar tissue from shear forces. The liner has the function of gripping the skin tightly and safely stabilizing and compressing the soft tissue.
SoftSkin S40CL • • • • • • • • • • •
Order No.
Shore hardness: 40 Without distal connector Wall thickness: 3 mm Length: 350 mm Good gripping effect of the silicone Soft padding Textile at distal end more resistant Textile covering facilitates rolling Comfortable and easy to handle For patients with mobility levels 1–3 NEW: Including Liner stand
Circumference in cm
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
S40CL-16
16
4 168 010 40 00 160
S40CL-30
30
4 168 010 40 00 300
S40CL-18
18
4 168 010 40 00 180
S40CL-32
32
4 168 010 40 00 320
S40CL-20
20
4 168 010 40 00 200
S40CL-34
34
4 168 010 40 00 340
S40CL-21
21
4 168 010 40 00 210
S40CL-36
36
4 168 010 40 00 360
S40CL-22
22
4 168 010 40 00 220
S40CL-38
38
4 168 010 40 00 380
S40CL-23.5
23,5
4 168 010 40 00 235
S40CL-40
40
4 168 010 40 00 400
S40CL-25
25
4 168 010 40 00 250
S40CL-42
42
4 168 010 40 00 420
S40CL-26.5
26,5
4 168 010 40 00 265
S40CL-45
45
4 168 010 40 00 450
S40CL-28
28
4 168 010 40 00 280
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
SoftSkin S50CL • • • • • • • • • • •
70
Shore hardness: 50 Without distal connector Wall thickness: 3 mm Length: 350 mm Good gripping effect of the silicone Soft padding Textile at distal end more resistant Textile covering facilitates rolling Comfortable and easy to handle For patients with mobility levels 2–4 NEW: Including Liner stand
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
S50CL-16
16
4 168 010 50 00 160
S50CL-30
30
4 168 010 50 00 300
S50CL-18
18
4 168 010 50 00 180
S50CL-32
32
4 168 010 50 00 320
S50CL-20
20
4 168 010 50 00 200
S50CL-34
34
4 168 010 50 00 340
S50CL-21
21
4 168 010 50 00 210
S50CL-36
36
4 168 010 50 00 360
S50CL-22
22
4 168 010 50 00 220
S50CL-38
38
4 168 010 50 00 380
S50CL-23.5
23,5
4 168 010 50 00 235
S50CL-40
40
4 168 010 50 00 400
S50CL-25
25
4 168 010 50 00 250
S50CL-42
42
4 168 010 50 00 420
S50CL-26.5
26,5
4 168 010 50 00 265
S50CL-45
45
4 168 010 50 00 450
S50CL-28
28
4 168 010 50 00 280
1.3 Functional Adapters
Circumference in cm
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Order No.
1.2 Modular Adapters
SoftSkin S50CL
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
SoftSkin TF
Article No.
STF-28
28
4 165 010 60 00 280
STF-30
30
4 165 010 60 00 300
STF-32
32
4 165 010 60 00 320
STF-34
34
4 165 010 60 00 340
STF-36
36
4 165 010 60 00 360
STF-38
38
4 165 010 60 00 380
STF-40
40
4 165 010 60 00 400
STF-42
42
4 165 010 60 00 420
STF-45
45
4 165 010 60 00 450
STF-50
50
4 165 010 60 00 500
STF-55
55
4 165 010 60 00 550
1.7 Cosmetic Covers 1.8 Stump Socks
Circumference in cm
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Shore hardness: 40 Wall thickness: 3 mm Length: 350 mm Distal connector Textile covering facilitates rolling Soft padding For patients with mobility levels 1–4 Has high transverse elasticity so flexibly adapts to residual limb shape The special combination of fabrics effectively minimizes longitudinal travel NEW: Including Liner stand
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb. 71
1.10 Socket Accessories
• • • • • • • • • •
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Service Parts for SoftSkin-Liner
NEW
Liner stand from plastic to store the liner after use or washing.
Order No.
Height
Base of stand Circumference
Top of stand Circumference
Weight
Article No.
E-LSG
480 mm
160 mm
60 mm
181 g
4 650 909 00 55 000
72
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Length in cm
Article No.
PX-16
16–19
33–36
4 144 030 00 00 160
PX-20
20–23
43–46
4 144 030 00 00 200
PX-24
24–27
43–46
4 144 030 00 00 240
PX-28
28–31
43–46
4 144 030 00 00 280
1.3 Functional Adapters
Wall thickness: 6 mm Without distal connector Transparent Uncoated EasyGel liner for a very comfortable fit Very elastic and adaptable gel especially in the popliteal area For bony and sensitive residual limbs Absorbs shocks and distributes pressure spots around the socket Suitable for diabetics
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
• • • • • • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
EasyLiner PX
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb.
Wall thickness: 6 mm or 6/3 mm Made of EasyGel with an outer fabric Distal connector Additional features, see EasyLiner PX above
1.8 Stump Socks
• • • •
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
EasyLiner DT
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Article No.
DT1-16
16–19
4 144 040 00 00 160
DT2-16
16–19
4 144 050 00 00 160
DT1-20
20–23
4 144 040 00 00 200
DT2-20
20–23
4 144 050 00 00 200
DT1-24
24–27
4 144 040 00 00 240
DT2-24
24–27
4 144 050 00 00 240
DT1-28
28–31
4 144 040 00 00 280
DT2-28
28–31
4 144 050 00 00 280
DT1-32
32–35
4 144 040 00 00 320
DT2-32
32–35
4 144 050 00 00 320
1.9 Valves
Wall thickness: distal 6 mm, proximal 3 mm
The circumference is measured 4 cm above the distal end of the residual limb. 73
1.10 Socket Accessories
Wall thickness: 6 mm
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Uniprox G30 GEL-Knee sleeve • Length 350 mm • Wall thickness 3 mm • Optimum grip on socket and skin • Smooth and abrasion-resistant textile • Thermoplastic formable (65°- 85°C) • High skin tolerance
Order No.
Size
distal circumference (cm)
proximal circumference (cm)
Article No.
G30-KS-S
S, 3mm
15-22
23-34
4 650 030 00 01 000
G30-KS-M
M, 3mm
21-30
29-43
4 650 030 00 02 000
G30-KS-L
L, 3mm
28-42
36-51
4 650 030 00 03 000
G30-KS-XL
XL, 3mm
34-50
42-60
4 650 030 00 04 000
G30-KS-XXL
XXL, 3mm
38-55
52-73
4 650 030 00 05 000
The circumference to be measured 10 cm above the middle of the patella.
EasySleeve • • • • • • •
Wall thickness: 6 mm Length: 330 mm Knee sleeve with fabric covering, good grip and comfortable fit Snug, comfortable fit on the leg, no tightness in the popliteal area Easy to handle due to textile covering (smooth surface) Recommended for transtibial prostheses without supracondylar walls. Conical shape
Order No.
Size
Circumference in cm
Article No.
L08-25
20 (S)
25–30
4 145 020 00 00 200
L08-31
24 (M)
31–37
4 145 020 00 00 240
L08-38
28 (L)
38–45
4 145 020 00 00 280
L08-46
32 (XL)
46–54
4 145 020 00 00 320
The circumference is measured 20 cm above the center of the patella. 74
Wall thickness: 1.5 mm Length: 340 mm External smooth textile covering Very thin walls but still stable, holds shape Adequate for very active/highly mobile patients
1.3 Functional Adapters
• • • • •
1.2 Modular Adapters
Silicone Knee Sleeve
Article No.
L09-28
28–32
4 145 030 00 91 280
L09-33
33–34
4 145 030 00 91 330
L09-35
35–37
4 145 030 00 91 350
L09-38
38–40
4 145 030 00 91 380
L09-41
41–45
4 145 030 00 91 410
L09-46
46–51
4 145 030 00 91 460
L09-52
52–57
4 145 030 00 91 520
L09-58
58–64
4 145 030 00 91 580
1.5 Hip Joints
Circumference in cm
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
skin-colored Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
The circumference is measured 10 cm above the center of the patella.
Silicone Distal End Pads
Condylar circumference in cm
Article No.
L14-1
31–36
4 156 020 01 00 360
L14-2
38–40
4 156 020 01 00 400
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Distal end pad for knee disarticulations, convex (for intercondylar fossa)
Order No.
Condylar circumference in cm
Article No.
L15-1
31–36
4 156 020 02 00 360
L15-2
38–40
4 156 020 02 00 400
75
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
Distal end pad for knee disarticulations, concave
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Locking Devices Overview
Smooth/Slightly Corrugated Pin
Uniprox Prosthetics offers a wide range of locking devices providing the optimal solution for your patients.
ShL4A Art. No. 4 147 140 01 00 000
ShL2 Art. No. 4 147 020 00 11 000
ShL4B Art. No. 4 147 050 00 11 000
Ratchet Locks
Clutch Locks
ShL1 Art. No. 4 147 110 01 00 000
ShL3A-2 (hexagonal, waterproof) Art. No. 4 147 009 58 00 000
76
ShL5B Art. No. 4 147 030 00 11 001
1.2 Modular Adapters
ShL1 Locking Device
NEW 1
Version
Weight limit
Weight
Installation Height
Article No.
ShL1
Locking device with partially grooved pin
depends on laminate
78 g
23 mm
4 147 110 01 00 000
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
The ShL1 is laminated securely into the socket with or without a dummy (E-ShL52), but can be accessed at any time through the inside of the socket. The innovative lamination procedure is made fast and simple with the integrated silicone sealing rings and the new set of lamination dummies which reliably prevent the resin from flowing into the adaptor. Delivery includes: ShL1 incl. funnel Ø 58 mm, funnel Ø 76 mm, lamination dummy set, smooth pin and a slightly corrugated pin.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-ShL02
Pin, smooth, 55 mm
4 147 019 00 00 002
no pict.
E-ShL03
Pin, smooth, 55 mm
4 147 019 00 00 003
no pict.
E-ShL54
Pin, smooth, with grooved cone point
4 620 009 00 33 001
E-ShL06
Push button, black
4 147 019 00 00 006
no pict.
E-ShL07
Spring with silicone base
4 147 019 00 00 007
no pict.
E-ShL08
Clamp disks, 2 pieces
4 147 019 00 00 008
no pict.
E-ShL09
Mechanism for ShL1 & ShL5A*
4 147 019 00 00 009
no pict.
E-ShL10
Lamination dummy set for ShL1
4 147 019 00 00 010
no pict.
E-ShL11
Funnel ø 58 mm, for ShL1
4 147 019 08 00 000
no pict.
E-ShL12
Funnel ø 76 mm, for ShL1
4 147 019 09 00 000
no pict.
E-ShL13
Two-hole wrench
4 147 019 10 00 000
2
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No.
1
1.9 Valves
1
Please order the desired socket adapter to be laminated and the distal adapter separately using the information in the Modular Adapters category.
* includes spring, sleeve, sliding unit and push button
77
1.10 Socket Accessories
!
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Service Parts for ShL1
2
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
ShL2 Locking Device The Shl2 is laminated securely into the socket. Delivery includes: funnel, dummy and pin.
Order No.
Version
Weight
Installation Height
Article No.
ShL2
with clutch lock with toothed pin
99 g
38 mm
4 147 020 00 11 000
ShL3 Locking Device with Ratchet Lock The Shl3A-2 is laminated securely into the socket. Delivery includes: funnel, dummy and pin.
Order No.
Version
ShL3A-2
hexagonal, waterproof
Weight limit
Service Parts for ShL2
Weight
Installation Height
Article No.
86 g
38 mm
4 147 009 58 00 000
Service Parts for ShL3
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Order No.
Description
Article No.
ShL14
Mechanism for ShL2
4 147 009 56 00 000
E-ShL21
Pin, 55 mm (toothed)
4 147 049 01 22 000
ShL15
Dummy
4 147 009 57 00 000
E-ShL22
Pin, 90 mm (toothed)
4 147 049 02 22 000
ShL16
Wrench (to tighten pin)
4 147 009 59 00 000
E-ShL11
Funnel ø 58 mm
4 147 019 08 00 000
ShL17
Pin, 55 mm (toothed)
4 147 029 04 00 000
E-ShL23
Release push button
4 147 049 03 22 000
ShL18
Pin, 90 mm (toothed)
4 147 029 05 00 000
E-ShL24
Screw cap
4 147 049 04 22 000
ShL19
Push Button for ShL2
4 147 009 60 00 000
E-ShL25
Stainless steel ratchet
4 147 009 55 00 000
ShL11
Funnel ø 58 mm
4 147 019 08 00 000
E-ShL26
Stainless steel spring
4 147 049 06 22 000
ShL20
Spring for release button
4 233 151 05 00 000
E-ShL27
Patient‘s key
4 147 049 07 22 000
E-ShL28
Dummy, Mechanism
4 147 049 08 22 000
78
1.2 Modular Adapters
ShL4 Aluminum Locking Device, two-piece
1.3 Functional Adapters
The release mechanism of the ShL4 is easier to reach because it tilts slightly upward. This mechanism can be moved to the other side at any time. The ShL4â&#x20AC;&#x2DC;s lamination attachment (E-ShL 45) is laminated securely into the socket and vacuum-formed.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Delivery includes: ShL4 with lamination attachment, dummy sets, and pins
ShL4A
1.5 Hip Joints
2
Weight
Installation Height
Article No.
Pict.
with smooth + slightly corrugated pin
195 g
38 mm
4 147 140 01 00 000
1
Shl4B
with clutch lock (toothed)
210 g
42 mm
4 147 050 00 11 000
2 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
ShL4A
Weight limit
1.8 Stump Socks
Version
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1
79
1.10 Socket Accessories
!
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices Service Parts for ShL4 For Locking Device Order No.
Description
Shl4A
Shl4B
E-ShL39
External piece with locking mechanism
•
4 147 149 00 00 001
E-ShL40
Mechanism
•
4 147 149 00 00 004
E-ShL41
Screw mechanism
•
4 147 149 00 00 003
E-ShL01
Mounting aid for clamp disc
•
4 147 019 00 00 001
E-ShL02
Pin, smooth, 55 mm
•
4 147 019 00 00 002
E-ShL03
Pin, smooth, 90 mm
•
4 147 019 00 00 003
E-ShL04
Pin, slightly corrugated, 55 mm
•
4 147 019 00 00 004
E-ShL05
Pin, slightly corrugated, 90 mm
•
4 147 019 00 00 005
E-ShL06
Push button, black
•
4 147 019 00 00 006
E-ShL07
Spring with silicone base
•
4 147 019 00 00 007
E-ShL08
Clamp disks, 2 pieces
•
4 147 019 00 00 008
E-ShL16
Wrench (to tighten pin)
•
Article No.
4 147 009 59 00 000
E-ShL17
Pin, 55 mm (toothed)
•
4 147 029 04 00 000
E-ShL18
Pin, 90 mm (toothed)
•
4 147 029 05 00 000
E-ShL42
External piece with locking mechanism
•
4 147 059 01 11 000
1
2
3
4
For Locking Device Order No.
Description
Shl4A
Shl4B
Article No.
Pict.
E-ShL44
Dummy, Positive Model Attachment Piece
•
•
4 147 059 05 00 001
1
E-ShL45
Lamination Attachment Plate
•
•
4 147 059 02 00 000
2
E-ShL46
Plastic connection screw
•
•
4 147 059 04 00 000
3
E-ShL47
Transition Piece, Stainless Steel
•
•
4 147 059 03 00 000
4
80
ShL5B Locking Device
Delivery includes: UHU adhesive
1
Version
Shl5B
with clutch lock (toothed)
Material
Weight
Installation Height
Article No.
Pict.
Aluminium
126 g
40 mm
4 147 030 00 11 001
1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Order the socket adapter needed for lamination and the distal adapter separately using the information in the Modular Adapters category.
1.9 Valves
!
Weight limit
81
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
!
1.3 Functional Adapters
Due to the reduced construction height of 35 mm, the field of application has been expanded to include patient care with long residual limbs. The ShL5B is proximal screwed onto M36 x 1,5 external thread on a laminated socket and distal screwed onto a M36 x 1,5 internal thread on a laminated socket adapter.
1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices Service Parts for ShL5B Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-ShL16
Wrench (to tighten pin)
4 147 009 59 00 000
E-ShL17
Pin, 55 mm (toothed)
4 147 029 04 00 000
E-ShL18
Pin, 90 mm (toothed)
4 147 029 05 00 000
E-ShL48
Mechanism
4 147 039 02 11 000
E-ShL49
Push button, plastic
4 147 039 06 00 000
!
Accessories for the locking devices can be found in the Modular Adapters category. Accessories for the lamination attachments and dummy sets can be found in the Modular Adapters category.
2
1
Order No.
Description
Height
Diameter
Article No.
Pict.
E-ShL52
Lamination dummy
45 mm
68 mm
4 147 009 02 00 000
1
E-ShL53
Lamination dummy
37 mm
50 mm
4 147 009 03 00 000
2
82
Description
Article No.
Pict.
EM
Pulling-in Mechanism for thighs and lower leg prostheses
4147 000 00 00 001
no pict.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
Order No.
1.2 Modular Adapters
Pulling-in Mechanism
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
4
3
5 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
2
Article No.
Pict.
E-EM01
Lamination body
4 147 009 00 00 001
1
E-EM02
Perlon cord 1,5m
4 147 009 00 00 002
no pict.
E-EM03
Coupling screw with perlon cord
4 147 009 00 00 003
2
E-EM04
Cover for perlon cord
4 147 009 00 00 004
3
E-EM05
Clamp for perlon cord
4 147 009 00 00 005
4
1.8 Stump Socks
Description
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Service Parts for Pulling-in Mechanism
83
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Pulling-in Mechanism
1
2
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Abb.
E1
Pulling-in Mechanism for Transtibial Prostheses
4 147 009 06 00 000
1
E2
Pulling-in Mechanism for Transfemoral Prostheses
4 147 009 07 00 000
2
1
2
3
5
6
7
4
9 10
11
8
Service Parts for Pulling-in Mechanism Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-E01
Coupling screw with perlon cord
4 147 009 08 00 000
1
E-E02
Connection for distal coupling
4 147 009 09 00 000
2
E-E03
Distal coupling disk
4 147 009 10 00 000
3
E-E04
Perlon cord for coupling screw 1.5 m
4 147 009 11 00 000
4
E-E05
Knurled nut
4 147 009 12 00 000
5
E-E06
Washer for knurled nut
4 147 009 13 00 000
6
E-E07
Fastening disk for perlon cord
4 147 009 14 00 000
7
E-E08
Spindle for knurled nut
4 147 009 15 00 000
8
E-E09
Cover for perlon cord
4 147 009 16 00 000
9
E-E10
Transfemoral Connection disk
4 147 009 17 00 000
10
E-E11
Lamination dummy
4 147 009 18 00 000
11
84
1.2 Modular Adapters
Vakuum-Jet 1
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.3 Functional Adapters
The new vacuum system is integrated in the distal prosthetic socket. It aims to improve adhesion between the prosthetic interface and the residual limb. Special features of the Vacuum-Jet: The Vacuum-Jet provides a temporary vacuum, thus the residual limb is not exerted to vacuum permanently and may relax in the non-weight bearing phases. The patient can definitely feel the improvement in comfort.
Technical Highlights:
Proximal Adaption
Distal Adaption
VJ1
Vacuum-Jet
M36-threat
pyramid
Weight limit
Article No. 4 175 000 77 00 000
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Description
Temporary Vacuum
1.8 Stump Socks
Reduced air flow Air inflation in non-weight bearing phases
nozzle body 1.9 Valves
Increased air flow Air deflation in weight bearing phases
85
1.10 Socket Accessories
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Improvement of comfort and quality of life by: • Secure adhesion of the prosthetic interface • Better guidance and control of the prosthesis • Improvement of comfort while seated • Low system weight
1 Prosthetics 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Vakuum-Jet 2
NEW
The new “Vakuum Jet 2” ventilation system can be freely positioned in the socket or retrofitted as well. In combination with a vacuumforming knee cap, it creates a temporary vacuum for fixing the stump within the prosthetic socket by removing air penetrated into the socket during each step. In the resting phase, it allows for a minimal reflux, significantly reducing the negative pressure in the socket which is unpleasant for the user.
Technical Highlights: • freely positionable in the socket • can also be retrofitted • creates a temporary vacuum in the socket • reduces unpleasant negative pressure in the socket • head diameter: 12 mm • length: 16 mm • material: Stainless steel • set includes: Dummy plate with screw, sealing ring
Order No.
Description
Article No.
VJ2
Vakuum-Jet, freely positioned
4 663 050 00 00 000
VJ2 spare part For regular maintenance, a replacement kit comprising a set of filters, a protective cap and a sealing ring is available. Order No. E-VJ2
86
Description Replacement kit
Article No. 4 660 010 90 55 000
Ø5
Ø 80 mm
Ø 55 mm
5m
1.3 Functional Adapters
m
Ø 60 mm
Ø 45 mm
Ø 30 mm
Ø 30 mm 2
Ø 30 mm
3
4 1.5 Hip Joints
1
Ø 30 mm
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Ø 45 mm
for 30 mm tube systems Order No.
Calf circum-ference in cm
Side
Designed for knee joints
Article No.
Pict.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
2-step bore, anatomical shape 40
left
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 010 01 00 400
1
KS02-44L
44
left
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 010 01 00 440
1
KS02-40R
40
right
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 010 02 00 400
1
KS02-44R
44
right
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 010 02 00 440
1
KS03-40L
40
left
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 020 01 00 400
2
KS03-44L
44
left
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 020 01 00 440
2
KS03-40R
40
right
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 020 02 00 400
2
KS03-44R
44
right
JT01
JT02
JT03
4 150 020 02 00 440
2
Article No.
Pict.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
KS02-40L
for 34 mm and 35 mm tube systems Order No.
Calf circum-ference in cm
Side
Designed for knee joints
KS04-36L
36
left
JT05
4 150 030 01 00 360
3
KS04-40L
40
left
JT05
4 150 030 01 00 400
3
KS04-44L
44
left
JT05
4 150 030 01 00 440
3
KS04-36R
36
right
JT05
4 150 030 02 00 360
3
KS04-40R
40
right
JT05
4 150 030 02 00 400
3
KS04-44R
44
right
JT05
4 150 030 02 00 440
3
1.9 Valves
3-step bore, anatomical shape
1.8 Stump Socks
Ø 55 mm
1.2 Modular Adapters
Transfemoral Cosmetic Foam Cover
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
KS05-40L
40
left
4 150 120 01 00 400
4
KS05-44L
44
left
4 150 120 01 00 440
4
KS05-40R
40
right
4 150 120 02 00 400
4
KS05-44R
44
right
4 150 120 02 00 440
4 87
1.10 Socket Accessories
4-step bore, anatomical shape
1 Prosthetics 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Transfemoral Cosmetic Foam Cover
Ø 80 mm
Ø 80 mm
Ø 60 mm
Ø 60 mm
Ø 34/35 mm
Ø 34/35 mm
1
2
for 34/35 mm tube systems Order No.
Calf circumference in cm
Side
Designed for knee joints
Article No.
Pict.
3-step bore, conical AK bore, universal KS06-40L
40
left
JT09
JT20
4 150 040 01 00 400
1
KS06-44L
44
left
JT09
JT20
4 150 040 01 00 440
2
KS06-40R
40
right
JT09
JT20
4 150 040 02 00 400
1
KS06-44R
44
right
JT09
JT20
4 150 040 02 00 440
2
2-step bore, universal, for large circumferences KS07-46L
46
left
JT09
JT20
4 150 060 01 00 000
no pict.
KS07-46R
46
right
JT09
JT20
4 150 060 02 00 000
no pict.
KS07-52
52
left/right
JT09
JT20
4 150 050 00 00 000
no pict.
88
1.2 Modular Adapters
Transtibial Cosmetic Covers
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Ø 30 mm bore
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
squared shape, 1-step
Version
Color
Article No.
KS20
Polyethylene rigid foam
skin
4 150 080 02 00 000 1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
Order No.
Version
Color
Article No.
Pict.
KS21
Polyurethane soft foam, Ø 30 mm bore
skin
4 150 090 01 00 000
1
1.8 Stump Socks
conical shape, 2-step Ø 80 mm
1.9 Valves
120 mm
400 mm
Ø 30 mm Order No.
Version
Color
Article No.
KS24
Hard foam
skin
4 150 090 03 00 000 89
1.10 Socket Accessories
1
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
conical shape, 1-step
1 Prosthetics 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
90
Made of Perlon, for transfemoral prostheses, delivery unit = 2 pcs. Leg length / cm
Band circumference / cm
Foot length / cm Article No.
KS41-0
45
36
20,0
4 150 009 01 00 000
KS41-1
55
36
20,0
4 150 009 01 00 001
KS41-2
65
38
20,0
4 150 009 01 00 002
KS41-3
75
40
21,0
4 150 009 01 00 003
KS41-4
80
40
21,0
4 150 009 01 00 004
Made of Perlon, for transtibial prostheses, delivery unit = 2 pcs. Leg length / cm
Band circumfe- Foot length / cm Article No. rence / cm
KS42-1
36
25
20,0
4 150 009 02 00 001
KS42-2
41
25
21,0
4 150 009 02 00 002
KS42-3
46
27
22,0
4 150 009 02 00 003
Order No.
Version
Article No.
KS45
0.5 kg roll, width: 13.5 cm
4 150 009 03 00 000
Order No.
Leg length / cm
Band circumfe- designed for rence / cm
Article No.
KS45-1
70
31
BK
4 150 009 03 00 310
KS45-2
110
43
AK
4 150 009 03 00 430
KS45-3
110
48
AK
4 150 009 03 00 480
91
1.9 Valves
Made of nylon Helanca, to be stitched down under the sole and glued
1.10 Socket Accessories
Cosmetic Skin
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
1.2 Modular Adapters
Cosmetic Stockings
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
COMFORGEL Stump Sock with a Silicone Inner Layer • Releases skin care oil (dermatologically inert) • For very sensitive residual limbs • Shock absorbing • For dry skin, e.g., in patients with diabetes • Soft and adaptable • Durable due to distal nylon reinforcement • Length of silicone inner layer: 23 cm • For residual limbs of up to 42 cm circumference
Order No.
Length in cm
Thickness/Ply
Distal Hole
Color of Prox. Border
Article No.
L05-3
36
3
No
yellow
4 143 080 03 00 000
L05-5
36
5
No
green
4 143 080 05 00 000
Gel Stump Sock • 2 layer with Gel • With Silipos® Mineral-Oil • Improves visual nature of the skin • Less skin friction • Soft and cuddly • Washable Order No.
Gel-Height
Length
distal circumference
proximal circumference
distal Article No. hole
L30-1
20 cm
25 cm - 33 cm
17 cm - 24 cm
17 cm - 26 cm
no
4 660 010 00 01 000
L30-2
25 cm
38 cm - 43 cm
18 cm - 28 cm
18 cm - 32 cm
no
4 660 010 00 02 000
L30-3
25 cm
38 cm - 43 cm
20 cm - 34 cm
20 cm - 38 cm
no
4 660 010 00 03 000
L30-4
33 cm
43 cm - 48 cm
20 cm - 34 cm
20 cm - 38 cm
no
4 660 010 00 04 000
L30-5
25 cm
43 cm - 48 cm
23 cm - 37 cm
23 cm - 43 cm
no
4 660 010 00 05 000
L30-6
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
23 cm - 37 cm
23 cm - 43 cm
no
4 660 010 00 06 000
L30-7
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
28 cm - 42 cm
28 cm - 49 cm
no
4 660 010 00 07 000
L30-8
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
31 cm - 50 cm
31 cm - 56 cm
no
4 660 010 00 08 000
proximal circumference
distal Article No. hole
• 3 layer with Gel • With Silipos® Mineral-Oil • Improves visual nature of the skin • Less skin friction • Soft and cuddly • Washable
92
Order No.
Gel-Height
Length
distal circumference
L35-1
20 cm
25 cm - 33 cm
17 cm - 24 cm
17 cm - 26 cm
no
4 660 020 00 01 000
L35-2
25 cm
38 cm - 43 cm
18 cm - 28 cm
18 cm - 32 cm
no
4 660 020 00 02 000
L35-3
25 cm
38 cm - 43 cm
20 cm - 34 cm
20 cm - 38 cm
no
4 660 020 00 03 000
L35-4
33 cm
43 cm - 48 cm
20 cm - 34 cm
20 cm - 38 cm
no
4 660 020 00 04 000
L35-5
25 cm
43 cm - 48 cm
23 cm - 37 cm
23 cm - 43 cm
no
4 660 020 00 05 000
L35-6
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
23 cm - 37 cm
23 cm - 43 cm
no
4 660 020 00 06 000
L35-7
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
28 cm - 42 cm
28 cm - 49 cm
no
4 660 020 00 07 000
L35-8
33 cm
46 cm - 53 cm
31 cm - 50 cm
31 cm - 56 cm
no
4 660 020 00 08 000
1.2 Modular Adapters
Cotton Stump Socks ST10 Cotton Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with CoolMed fibers
Length in cm
Article No.
ST10-20
20
4 236 040 00 89 020
ST10-25
25
4 236 040 00 89 025
ST10-30
30
4 236 040 00 89 030
ST10-35
35
4 236 040 00 89 035
ST10-40
40
4 236 040 00 89 040
ST10-45
45
4 236 040 00 89 045
ST10-50
50
4 236 040 00 89 050
ST10-55
55
4 236 040 00 89 055
ST10-60
60
4 236 040 00 89 060
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
Material composition: 95% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 5% polyamide Machine wash at 60 °C, color: white
25
4 236 040 10 89 025
30
4 236 040 10 89 030
ST10-35-10
35
4 236 040 10 89 035
ST10-40-10
40
4 236 040 10 89 040
ST10-45-10
45
4 236 040 10 89 045
ST10-50-10
50
4 236 040 10 89 050
ST10-55-10
55
4 236 040 10 89 055
→ Stays fresh for long periods
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
→ Skin stays dry longer
93
1.10 Socket Accessories
• Antimicrobial • Wicks moisture away from the skin
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
ST10-25-10 ST10-30-10
1.5 Hip Joints
ST10 Cotton Stump Socks for transtibial prostheses, 10 pack
* The CoolMed fibers have the following properties:
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST12 Cotton Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with distal hole and CoolMed fibers Material composition: 95% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 5% polyamide Machine wash at 60 °C, color: white Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST12-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 020
ST12-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 025
ST12-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 030
ST12-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 035
ST12-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 040
ST12-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 045
ST12-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 050
ST12-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 055
ST12-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 030 00 89 060
ST13 Cotton Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with distal hole Material composition: 95% cotton, 5% elasthan Machine wash at 60 °C, color: natural Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST13-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 020
ST13-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 025
ST13-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 030
ST13-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 035
ST13-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 040
ST13-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 045
ST13-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 050
ST13-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 055
ST13-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 060 00 00 060
ST23 Cotton Stump Sock for transfemoral prostheses with distal hole Material composition: 95% cotton, 5% elasthan Machine wash at 60 °C, color: natural Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST23-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 020
ST23-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 025
ST23-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 030
ST23-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 035
ST23-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 040
ST23-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 045
ST23-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 150 00 00 050
* The CoolMed fibers have the following properties: • Antimicrobial • Wicks moisture away from the skin
94
→ Stays fresh for long periods → Skin stays dry longer
1.2 Modular Adapters
Terry Stump Socks ST31 Terry Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with CoolMed fibers
Article No.
ST31-20W
20
4 236 020 00 89 020
ST31-25W
25
4 236 020 00 89 025
ST31-30W
30
4 236 020 00 89 030
ST31-35W
35
4 236 020 00 89 035
ST31-40W
40
4 236 020 00 89 040
ST31-45W
45
4 236 020 00 89 045
ST31-50W
50
4 236 020 00 89 050
ST31-55W
55
4 236 020 00 89 055
ST31-60W
60
4 236 020 00 89 060
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Length in cm
1.3 Functional Adapters
Material composition: 85% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 15% polyamide Machine wash at 60 °C, color: white Order No.
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
4 236 020 10 89 025
ST31-30W-10
30
4 236 020 10 89 030
ST31-35W-10
35
4 236 020 10 89 035
ST31-40W-10
40
4 236 020 10 89 040
ST31-45W-10
45
4 236 020 10 89 045
ST31-50W-10
50
4 236 020 10 89 050
ST31-55W-10
55
4 236 020 10 89 055
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
25
* The CoolMed fibers have the following properties: • Antimicrobial • Wicks moisture away from the skin
→ Stays fresh for long periods → Skin stays dry longer 95
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
ST31-25W-10
1.5 Hip Joints
ST31 Terry Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses, 10 pack
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST33 Terry Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with distal hole and CoolMed fibers Material composition: 85% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 15% polyamide Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST33-20W
20
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 020
ST33-25W
25
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 025
ST33-30W
30
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 030
ST33-35W
35
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 035
ST33-40W
40
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 040
ST33-45W
45
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 045
ST33-50W
50
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 050
ST33-55W
55
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 055
ST33-60W
60
Silicone opening
4 236 010 00 89 060
ST31 Terry Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses, 10 pack
96
ST33-25W-10
25
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 025
ST33-30W-10
30
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 030
ST33-35W-10
35
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 035
ST33-40W-10
40
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 040
ST33-45W-10
45
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 045
ST33-50W-10
50
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 050
ST33-55W-10
55
Silicone opening
4 236 010 10 89 055
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST41 Terry Stump Sock for transfemoral prostheses with CoolMed fibers
Article No.
ST41-20
20
4 236 140 00 00 020
ST41-25
25
4 236 140 00 00 025
ST41-30
30
4 236 140 00 00 030
ST41-35
35
4 236 140 00 00 035
ST41-40
40
4 236 140 00 00 040
ST41-45
45
4 236 140 00 00 045
ST41-50
50
4 236 140 00 00 050
ST41-55
55
4 236 140 00 00 055
ST41-60
60
4 236 140 00 00 060
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Length in cm
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.3 Functional Adapters
Material composition: 85% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 15% elasthan Machine wash at 60 °C, color: white
ST43 Terry Stump Sock for transfemoral prostheses with distal hole and CoolMed fibers
Type of hole
Article No.
20
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 020
25
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 025
ST43-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 030
ST43-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 035
ST43-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 040
ST43-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 045
ST43-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 050
ST43-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 055
ST43-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 130 00 89 060
* The CoolMed fibers have the following properties: • Antimicrobial • Wicks moisture away from the skin
→ Stays fresh for long periods → Skin stays dry longer 97
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
ST43-20 ST43-25
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Length in cm
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No.
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Material composition: 85% cotton with CoolMed fibers*, 15% elasthan Machine wash at 60 °C, color: natural
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
Nylon Stump Socks ST52 Nylon Stump Sock for transtibial prostheses with distal hole Material composition: 100% nylon Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST52-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 020
ST52-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 025
ST52-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 030
ST52-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 035
ST52-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 040
ST52-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 045
ST52-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 050
ST52-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 055
ST52-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 080 00 00 060
ST62 Nylon Stump Sock for transfemoral prostheses with distal hole Material composition: 100% nylon Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
98
Order No.
Length in cm
Article No.
ST62-20
20
4 236 170 00 00 020
ST62-25
25
4 236 170 00 00 025
ST62-30
30
4 236 170 00 00 030
ST62-35
35
4 236 170 00 00 035
ST62-40
40
4 236 170 00 00 040
ST62-45
45
4 236 170 00 00 045
ST62-50
50
4 236 170 00 00 050
1.2 Modular Adapters
Stump socks, proximal-distal, different qualities
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST70 Stump Sock 2/3 cotton (proximal) and 1/3 terry (distal) for transtibial prostheses
Order No.
Length in cm
Article No.
ST70-20
20
4 236 250 01 00 020
ST70-25
25
4 236 250 01 00 025
ST70-30
30
4 236 250 01 00 030
ST70-35
35
4 236 250 01 00 035
ST70-40
40
4 236 250 01 00 040
ST70-45
45
4 236 250 01 00 045
ST70-50
50
4 236 250 01 00 050
ST70-55
55
4 236 250 01 00 055
ST70-60
60
4 236 250 01 00 060
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Terry
1.5 Hip Joints
Cotton
1.3 Functional Adapters
Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
ST71 Stump Sock 2/3 cotton (proximal) and 1/3 terry (distal) for transtibial prostheses with distal hole
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST71-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 020
ST71-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 025
ST71-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 030
ST71-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 035
ST71-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 040
ST71-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 045
ST71-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 050
ST71-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 055
ST71-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 250 03 00 060
1.8 Stump Socks
Order No.
1.9 Valves
Terry
99
1.10 Socket Accessories
Cotton
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST72 Stump Sock 2/3 terry (proximal) and 1/3 cotton (distal) for transtibial prostheses Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
Terry
Cotton
Order No.
Length in cm
Article No.
ST72-20
20
4 236 250 02 00 020
ST72-25
25
4 236 250 02 00 025
ST72-30
30
4 236 250 02 00 030
ST72-35
35
4 236 250 02 00 035
ST72-40
40
4 236 250 02 00 040
ST72-45
45
4 236 250 02 00 045
ST72-50
50
4 236 250 02 00 050
ST72-55
55
4 236 250 02 00 055
ST72-60
60
4 236 250 02 00 060
ST73 Stump Sock 2/3 terry (proximal) and 1/3 cotton (distal) for transtibial prostheses with distal hole Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
Terry
100
Cotton
Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST73-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 020
ST73-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 025
ST73-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 030
ST73-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 035
ST73-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 040
ST73-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 045
ST73-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 050
ST73-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 055
ST73-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 250 04 00 060
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST74 Stump Sock 2/3 terry (proximal) and 1/3 nylon (distal) for transtibial prostheses
Order No.
Length in cm
Article No.
ST74-20
20
4 236 250 05 00 020
ST74-25
25
4 236 250 05 00 025
ST74-30
30
4 236 250 05 00 030
ST74-35
35
4 236 250 05 00 035
ST74-40
40
4 236 250 05 00 040
ST74-45
45
4 236 250 05 00 045
ST74-50
50
4 236 250 05 00 050
ST74-55
55
4 236 250 05 00 055
ST74-60
60
4 236 250 05 00 060
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Nylon
1.5 Hip Joints
Terry
1.3 Functional Adapters
Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
Order No.
Length in cm
Type of hole
Article No.
ST75-20
20
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 020
ST75-25
25
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 025
ST75-30
30
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 030
ST75-35
35
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 035
ST75-40
40
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 040
ST75-45
45
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 045
ST75-50
50
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 050
ST75-55
55
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 055
ST75-60
60
Silicone opening
4 236 250 06 00 060
1.9 Valves
Nylon
101
1.10 Socket Accessories
Terry
1.8 Stump Socks
Machine wash at 60 째C, color: white
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
ST75 Stump Sock 2/3 terry (proximal) and 1/3 nylon (distal) for transtibial prostheses with distal hole
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
Stump Sheaths
ST80 Nylon Compression Sheaths for transtibial prostheses Stump covering used as an interface between the residual limb and the socket. This knit compression sheath protects the skin from chafing caused by wearing the prosthesis. Special features: Very fine knit and uniform fabric. The hem is barely noticeable and is not rolled. Slightly elastic, wrinkle-free fit. Cleaning information: Wash with lukewarm water and a neutral detergent.
Double seam
Order No.
Identification thread
Circumference A in cm
Length B in cm
Article No.
ST80-01
gray
18–23
20–32
4 236 200 01 00 000
ST80-02
light brown
18–23
32–48
4 236 200 02 00 000
ST80-03
yellow
18–23
45–64
4 236 200 03 00 000
ST80-04
light blue
18–23
60–87
4 236 200 04 00 000
ST80-05
reddish brown
21–27
20–32
4 236 200 05 00 000
ST80-06
blue
21–27
32–48
4 236 200 06 00 000
ST80-07
red
21–27
45–64
4 236 200 07 00 000
ST80-08
brown
21–27
60–87
4 236 200 08 00 000
ST80-09
black
24–32
20–32
4 236 200 09 00 000
ST80-10
dark green
24–32
32–48
4 236 200 10 00 000
ST80-11
dark gray
24–32
45–64
4 236 200 11 00 000
ST80-12
green
24–32
60–87
4 236 200 12 00 000
102
1.2 Modular Adapters
ST81 Nylon Compression Sheaths for Knee Disarticulation
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
1.3 Functional Adapters
Stump covering used as an interface between the residual limb and the socket. This finely knit compression sheath protects the skin from chafing caused by wearing the prosthesis. Special features: Very fine knit and uniform fabric. The hem is barely noticeable and is not rolled. Slightly elastic, wrinkle-free fit. Cleaning information: Wash with lukewarm water and a neutral detergent.
Double seam
Circumference A
Identification thread
Circumference A in cm
Length B in cm
Circumference C in cm
Article No.
ST81-1
gray/brown
20–40
32–34
36–72
4 236 220 01 00 000
ST81-2
gray/yellow
20–40
34–40
36–72
4 236 220 02 00 000
ST81-3
gray/red
20–40
38–46
36–72
4 236 220 03 00 000
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
Stump Sheaths ST82 Nylon Compression Sheaths for transfemoral prostheses
1.8 Stump Socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Stump covering used as an interface between the residual limb and the socket. This finely knit compression sheath protects the skin from chafing caused by wearing the prosthesis. Special features: Very fine knit and uniform fabric. The hem is barely noticeable and is not rolled. Slightly elastic, wrinkle-free fit. Cleaning information: Wash with lukewarm water and a neutral mild detergent.
Double seam
Circumference A
Order No.
Identification thread
Circumference A in cm
Length B in cm
Circumference C in cm
Article No.
ST82-1
dark brown/yellow
20–40
20–30
36–72
4 236 210 01 00 000
ST82-2
dark brown/green
20–40
30–45
36–72
4 236 210 02 00 000
ST82-3
dark brown/blue
20–40
45–70
36–72
4 236 210 03 00 000 103
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
Length B
Circumference C
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
Length B
Circumference C
1 Prosthetics 1.8 Stump Socks
ST89 - 91 Nylon Protective Sheaths Fine, highly elastic nylon sheath that can be worn under the cotton stump sock like a second skin. The smooth outside and rough inside adheres the sheath to the skin and guarantees that the cotton stump sock slides on easily. Cleaning information: Wash with lukewarm water and a mild neutral detergent. Color: white, 1 delivery unit = 2 pieces
Order No.
Length in cm
Article No.
ST89-30
30
4 236 230 02 00 030
ST89-35
35
4 236 230 02 00 035
ST89-40
40
4 236 230 02 00 040
ST89-45
45
4 236 230 02 00 045
ST89-50
50
4 236 230 02 00 050
ST89-55
55
4 236 230 02 00 055
ST89-60
60
4 236 230 02 00 060
ST90-30
30
4 236 230 03 00 030
ST90-35
35
4 236 230 03 00 035
ST90-40
40
4 236 230 03 00 040
ST90-45
45
4 236 230 03 00 045
ST90-50
50
4 236 230 03 00 050
ST90-55
55
4 236 230 03 00 055
ST90-60
60
4 236 230 03 00 060
ST91-30
30
4 236 230 04 00 030
ST91-35
35
4 236 230 04 00 035
ST91-40
40
4 236 230 04 00 040
ST91-45
45
4 236 230 04 00 045
ST91-50
50
4 236 230 04 00 050
ST91-55
55
4 236 230 04 00 055
ST91-60
60
4 236 230 04 00 060
top width 16 cm
top width 18 cm
top width 20 cm
104
1
1.2 Modular Adapters
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
2
Flat Rubber Valve
Valve ring
Features: with thumb flap, without valve ring, inside diameter: 24 mm Material: rubber/silicone
Application: for flat rubber valves with an inside diameter of 24 mm
Order No.
Valve ring outside Ø Article No. in mm
Pict.
Order No.
Valve ring outside Ø in mm
Article No.
V02
40
1
E-VO1
40
4 233 030 00 00 000 2
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Pict.
Article No.
Pict.
E-VO2
40
4 233 080 00 00 000 3
1.8 Stump Socks
Valve ring outside Ø in mm
1.9 Valves
Order No.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Tube with Valve Seat
105
1.10 Socket Accessories
4 233 020 00 00 000
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
3
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets
1
5 3
4
2
Socket Valve (V08) Features: for flexible sockets, with automatic air expulsion, with plastic key for the patient (Pict. 7) Valve head Ø = 27.8 mm, Bore Ø = 32 mm Material: Aluminum Order No.
Article No.
Pict.
V08
4 233 090 00 00 000
1
Service Parts and Accessories for Socket Valves V08 and V09 Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-V03
Valve body, with automatic air expulsion, for V08
4 233 091 03 00 000
2
E-V07
Valve Dummy for V08 and V09
4 233 091 04 00 000
3
E-V08
Special key for tightening the valve seat for valves V08 and V09
4 233 091 06 00 000
4
E-V09
Patient‘s key
4 233 091 07 00 000
5
106
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets As of now, Uniprox presents the new generation of the V09 valve. This is a stem valve with manual air emission for test and interim sockets, which is integrated directly into the material of the test sockets.
NEW
1.1 Prosthetic Feet 1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
• large valve opening • without automatic air expulsion • material: plastic • valve hight 20 mm • valve opening diameter: inside 30 mm, outside 35 mm • set includes: dummy with pin, 2 deep drawing socks
1.2 Modular Adapters
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
Description
Article No.
V09
Valve complete without automatic air expulsion
4 233 100 00 00 000
As of now, Uniprox presents the new generation of the V09 valve. This is a stem valve with automatic air emission for test and interim sockets, which is integrated directly into the material of the test sockets.
NEW
Order No.
Description
Article No.
V09-A
Valve complete with automatic air expulsion
4 663 040 00 00 000
107
1.10 Socket Accessories
1.9 Valves
1.8 Stump Socks
• large valve opening • with automatic air expulsion • material: plastic • valve hight 20 mm • valve opening diameter: inside 30 mm, outside 35 mm • set includes: dummy with pin, 2 deep drawing socks
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
Order No.
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets 1
2
3
5
4
6
Socket Valve The valve is designed for use in vacuum-formed sockets. Valve head Ø = 24 mm, Bore Ø = 28 mm Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
V13
Valve for plastic sockets
4 233 140 00 00 000
1
Article No.
Pict.
Service Parts and Accessories for V13 Order No.
Description
E-V15
Inner Valve Housing for Socket Valve
4 233 141 01 00 000
2
E-V16
Valve Housing for Socket Valve
4 233 141 03 00 000
3
E-V17
Dummy for Socket Valve
4 233 141 05 00 000
4
E-V18
Patient‘s Key for Socket Valve
4 233 141 06 00 000
5
E-V19
Special Wrench for Valve
4 233 141 07 00 000
6
108
1.3 Functional Adapters
1.2 Modular Adapters
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
2
Contact Valve, compl.
Flat Rubber Valve
The contact valve lets the air flow out when the button is pressed. Valve head Ø = 33 mm, Bore Ø = 38 mm
The Flat Rubber Valve is a simple alternative for prostheses with flexible inner sockets. Valve head Ø = 33 mm, Bore Ø = 38 mm
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
V18
Contact Valve, complete
4 233 190 00 00 000
1
V20
Flat Rubber Valve, complete
4 233 200 00 00 000
2
Service Part for V20 Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-V36
Valve Housing
4 233 201 01 00 000
3 1.7 Cosmetic Covers
Order No.
1.5 Hip Joints
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
3
1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
1
1.8 Stump Socks
Alternatively, V02 and V04 can be used as valve inserts.
7
8
9
Service Parts for V12 Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-V21
Valve Body
4 233 191 01 00 000
5
E-V22
Valve Housing
4 233 191 02 00 000
6
E-V23
Valve Dummy
4 233 191 04 00 000
7
E-V24
Threaded Coupling Ring
4 233 191 05 00 000
8
E-V25
Sealing Ring
4 233 191 06 00 000
9 109
1.9 Valves
6
1.10 Socket Accessories
5
1 Prosthetics 1.9 Valves
Valves for Prosthetic Sockets
1
2
Expulsion Contact Valve, compl.
Jet Contact Valve, compl.
The semi-automatic expulsion contact valve is designed for short residual limbs. The air is expelled during gait and cannot flow back. Valve head Ø = 33 mm, Bore Ø = 38 mm
During ambulation, the Jet Contact Valve allows minimal air flow in and out of the prosthesis through a 0.8 mm opening. This prevents noises caused by sudden air escape along the socket walls. Valve head Ø = 33 mm, Bore Ø = 38 mm
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
V22
Expulsion Contact Valve, complete
4 233 230 00 00 000
1
V21
Jet Contact Valve, complete
4 233 220 00 00 000
2
4
3
5
6
Service Parts and Accessories for Misc. Valves Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-V32
Special Wrench for Valve Assembly (for V18, 19, 20, 21, 22)
4 233 240 00 00 000
3
E-V33
Valve Body for Jet Contact Valve (for V21, 22)
4 233 221 01 00 000
4
E-V34
Valve Body for Expulsion Contact Valve (for V21, 22)
4 233 231 01 00 000
5
E-V35
Expulsion Push Button for Expulsion Contact Valve (for V21, 22)
4 233 231 02 00 000
6
110
1.2 Modular Adapters
EasyProth® Donning Sleeve
1.1 Prosthetic Feet
1 Prosthetics 1.10 Socket Accessories
Size
Easy-XS
XS
Easy-S
' $
Easy-XL . "
-
. "
%
(
600
% /
*
+ %
%
&
"
720
XL *
Easy-XXL / 1
% 460
"
M L
Easy-L
-
. "
XXL -
820 820
. "
-0
# "
%
240
1000
4 152 010 01 00 002
" 260
1000
4 152 010 02 00 002
260
1000
4 152 010 03 00 002
310
1000
4 152 010 04 00 002
320
1000
4 152 010 05 00 002
320
1200
4 152 010 06 00 002
%
%
sheet can be found in1 the Measurement Sheet category. ! The measurement # 2 1.6 Liners and Locking Devices
,
S
#
Article No.
EasyProth® Accessories The EasyProth® Extender makes threading the EasyProth® in and pulling it out of the socket valve much easier. The EasyProth® Packer makes it simple and easy to store the donning aid in a pocket.
1.7 Cosmetic Covers
%
$ &
) Easy-M $
420 "
Length in mm
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Easy-E
EasyProth® Extender
4 152 020 00 00 001 1.8 Stump Socks
%
!
Circumference, bottom in mm
1.9 Valves
Prosthesis Bag
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Z01
Prosthesis bag with logo, 120 x 50 cm, delivery unit = 10 pieces
4 156 060 01 00 000 111
1.10 Socket Accessories
"
Circumference, top in mm
1.5 Hip Joints
Order No.
1.4 Prosthetic Knee Joints
1.3 Functional Adapters
The EasyProth® donning sleeve helps amputees correctly fit sockets when donning.
1 Prosthetics 1.10 Socket Accessories
Uniprox Skin Care Products
1
2
3
4
Silicone Cleaner Spray For disinfection of prostheses, liners and orthoses. • Antibacterial effect for optimal hygiene • Protective cleaner with neutral pH
• Prevents bad odors caused by sweat
Order No.
Description
Content, ml
Article No.
Pict.
PS-01
Silicone Cleaner Spray
500
4 146 020 00 00 000
1
Lubricating Fluid For easy donning of silicone liners. In a practical pump spray bottle. • Makes it easier to don and doff silicone liners • Protects skin through reduced friction
• Optimal lubrication
Order No.
Description
Content, ml
Article No.
Pict.
PS-02
Donning Aid
100
4 146 010 00 00 100
2
PS-03
Donning Aid, Refill Pack
500
4 146 019 00 00 500
w. pict.
Skin Protection Lotion Moisturizing lotion for daily care and regeneration of stressed areas of the skin. • Protective skin care for stressed skin on the residual limb • Optimal protection of sensitive skin • Botanical oils and panthenol soothe skin
• Absorbed quickly, does not leave a greasy film • No fragrance or color added
Order No.
Description
Content, ml
Article No.
Pict.
PS-04
Skin Protection Lotion
100
4 146 030 00 00 000
3
Cleani-Stump Skin-Protection and Disinfection Towels Cleani-Stump is ideal for quickly cleaning silicone liners, prostheses and orthoses. Individually packaged, ideal and practical, especially when on the go. Order No.
Description
Content
Article No.
Pict.
PS-05
Cleani Stump Cleansing Towels
50 towels
4 146 070 00 00 000
4
112
unique prosthetic solutions
2 Orthotics 2.1
Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2.2
Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
2.3
Hip Orthoses
2.4
Spinal Orthoses
2.5
Hand Orthoses
2.6
Cervical Orthoses
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
2 Orthotics 2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
OF01 Peroneal Orthosis Indication • Foot paralysis • Peroneal paralysis (foot drop) Features • Extremely lightweight transtibial orthoses, made of polypropylene • Calf padding • Thermoformable • Riveted closure strap • Lightweight • Good hygienic properties • Dynamic rollover restoring force • Open heel and calf Order No.
Shoe Size
Size
Side
Height
Length
Article No.
OF01-1L
35–40
S
left
260 mm
240 mm
4 533 010 01 00 260
OF01-2L
41–44
M
left
290 mm
280 mm
4 533 010 01 00 290
OF01-3L
41–44
L
left
340 mm
280 mm
4 533 010 01 00 340
OF01-4L
> 44
X
left
390 mm
300 mm
4 533 010 01 00 400
OF01-1R
35–40
S
right
260 mm
240 mm
4 533 010 02 00 260
OF01-2R
41–44
M
right
290 mm
280 mm
4 533 010 02 00 290
OF01-3R
41–44
L
right
340 mm
280 mm
4 533 010 02 00 340
OF01-4R
> 44
X
right
390 mm
300 mm
4 533 010 02 00 400
OF02 Peroneal Orthosis (carbon-fiber reinforced) Indication • Foot paralysis • Peroneal paralysis (foot drop) Features • Extremely lightweight transtibial orthoses with carbon-fiber reinforcement, made of polypropylene • Calf padding • Thermoformable • Riveted closure strap • Lightweight • Good hygienic properties • Dynamic rollover restoring force • Open heel and calf Order No.
Shoe Size
Size
Side
Height
Length
Article No.
OF02-1L
35–40
S
left
270 mm
240 mm
4 533 020 01 00 260
OF02-2L
41–44
M
left
290 mm
280 mm
4 533 020 01 00 290
OF02-3L
41–44
L
left
340 mm
280 mm
4 533 020 01 00 340
OF02-4L
> 44
X
left
390 mm
300 mm
4 533 020 01 00 400
OF02-1R
35–40
S
right
270 mm
240 mm
4 533 020 02 00 260
OF02-2R
41–44
M
right
290 mm
280 mm
4 533 020 02 00 290
OF02-3R
41–44
L
right
340 mm
280 mm
4 533 020 02 00 340
OF02-4R
> 44
X
right
390 mm
300 mm
4 533 020 02 00 400
114
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Service Parts for Peroneal-Orthosis
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
1
2.3 Hip Orthoses
2 3
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-OF01
Closure strap for OF01 with pile dot, for calf pad
4 533 010 00 00 000
1
E-OF02
Closure strap for OF01 with pile dot, for calf pad
4 533 021 01 00 000
2
E-OF03
Calf pad
4 533 021 02 00 000
3
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Order No.
2.5 Hand Orthoses
OF08 Resting Splint
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Indication • Temporary immobilization of the ankle and talocalcaneal joints • Post-op care Prevention and treatment of supinated foot Features • Thermoformable plastic • Comfortable, removable and washable inner padding • Adjustable extension strap Foam wedge included to customize fit Order No.
Shoe Size
Article No.
OF08-1
S = 21–26
4 532 010 01 00 000
OF08-2
M = 27–37
4 532 010 02 00 000
OF08-3
L = 38–44
4 532 010 03 00 000
115
2 Orthotics 2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
Anti-varus Shoe (Home Shoe) Indication • Functional treatment of pes adductus (sickle foot) • Passive correction of pes adductus Function This shoe has an integrated correction position. The molded rubber sole enables the child to walk without slipping.
!
Abduction position 6°, reinforced heel cap,, only for use during the day
With correction Order No.
Foot length in mm
Side
Article No.
Order No.
Foot length in mm
Side
Article No.
OF1-75L
75
left
4 512 030 01 00 075
OF1-75R
75
right
4 512 030 02 00 075
OF1-80L
80
left
4 512 030 01 00 080
OF1-80R
80
right
4 512 030 02 00 080
OF1-85L
85
left
4 512 030 01 00 085
OF1-85R
85
right
4 512 030 02 00 085
OF1-90L
90
left
4 512 030 01 00 090
OF1-90R
90
right
4 512 030 02 00 090
OF1-95L
95
left
4 512 030 01 00 095
OF1-95R
95
right
4 512 030 02 00 095
OF1-100L
100
left
4 512 030 01 00 100
OF1-100R
100
right
4 512 030 02 00 100
OF1-105L
105
left
4 512 030 01 00 105
OF1-105R
105
right
4 512 030 02 00 105
OF1-110L
110
left
4 512 030 01 00 110
OF1-110R
110
right
4 512 030 02 00 110
OF1-115L
115
left
4 512 030 01 00 115
OF1-115R
115
right
4 512 030 02 00 115
OF1-120L
120
left
4 512 030 01 00 120
OF1-120R
120
right
4 512 030 02 00 120
OF1-125L
125
left
4 512 030 01 00 125
OF1-125R
125
right
4 512 030 02 00 125
OF1-130L
130
left
4 512 030 01 00 130
OF1-130R
130
right
4 512 030 02 00 130
OF1-135L
135
left
4 512 030 01 00 135
OF1-135R
135
right
4 512 030 02 00 135
OF1-140L
140
left
4 512 030 01 00 140
OF1-140R
140
right
4 512 030 02 00 140
OF1-145L
145
left
4 512 030 01 00 145
OF1-145R
145
right
4 512 030 02 00 145
OF1-150L
150
left
4 512 030 01 00 150
OF1-150R
150
right
4 512 030 02 00 150
OF1-155L
155
left
4 512 030 01 00 155
OF1-155R
155
right
4 512 030 02 00 155
OF1-160L
160
left
4 512 030 01 00 160
OF1-160R
160
right
4 512 030 02 00 160
OF1-165L
165
left
4 512 030 01 00 165
OF1-165R
165
right
4 512 030 02 00 165
116
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Anti-varus Shoe (Home Shoe)
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
Order No.
Foot length in mm
Side
Article No.
Order No.
Foot length in mm
Side
Article No.
OF2-75L
75
left
4 512 040 01 00 075
OF2-75R
75
right
4 512 040 02 00 075
OF2-80L
80
left
4 512 040 01 00 080
OF2-80R
80
right
4 512 040 02 00 080
OF2-85L
85
left
4 512 040 01 00 085
OF2-85R
85
right
4 512 040 02 00 085
OF2-90L
90
left
4 512 040 01 00 090
OF2-90R
90
right
4 512 040 02 00 090
OF2-95L
95
left
4 512 040 01 00 095
OF2-95R
95
right
4 512 040 02 00 095
OF2-100L
100
left
4 512 040 01 00 100
OF2-100R
100
right
4 512 040 02 00 100
OF2-105L
105
left
4 512 040 01 00 105
OF2-105R
105
right
4 512 040 02 00 105
OF2-110L
110
left
4 512 040 01 00 110
OF2-110R
110
right
4 512 040 02 00 110
OF2-115L
115
left
4 512 040 01 00 115
OF2-115R
115
right
4 512 040 02 00 115
OF2-120L
120
left
4 512 040 01 00 120
OF2-120R
120
right
4 512 040 02 00 120
OF2-125L
125
left
4 512 040 01 00 125
OF2-125R
125
right
4 512 040 02 00 125
OF2-130L
130
left
4 512 040 01 00 130
OF2-130R
130
right
4 512 040 02 00 130
OF2-135L
135
left
4 512 040 01 00 135
OF2-135R
135
right
4 512 040 02 00 135
OF2-140L
140
left
4 512 040 01 00 140
OF2-140R
140
right
4 512 040 02 00 140
OF2-145L
145
left
4 512 040 01 00 145
OF2-145R
145
right
4 512 040 02 00 145
OF2-150L
150
left
4 512 040 01 00 150
OF2-150R
150
right
4 512 040 02 00 150
OF2-155L
155
left
4 512 040 01 00 155
OF2-155R
155
right
4 512 040 02 00 155
OF2-160L
160
left
4 512 040 01 00 160
OF2-160R
160
right
4 512 040 02 00 160
OF2-165L
165
left
4 512 040 01 00 165
OF2-165R
165
right
4 512 040 02 00 165
117
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Without correction
2.5 Hand Orthoses
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Function If only one foot is affected, the anti-varus shoe without correction is worn on the healthy foot.
2 Orthotics 2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
118
Order No.
Description
Ø in mm
Length / mm
Article No.
OB100-08
Torsion orthosis, complete + calf band (15-20 cm)
8
700
4 518 010 00 00 008
OB100-10
Torsion orthosis, complete + calf band (20-25 cm)
10
800
4 518 010 00 00 010
OB100-12
Torsion orthosis, complete + calf band (20-25 cm)
12
1000
4 518 010 00 00 012
OB100-16
Torsion orthosis, complete + calf band (20-25 cm)
16
1000
4 518 010 00 00 016
OB101-08
Torsion orthosis without calf band
8
700
4 518 020 00 00 008
OB101-10
Torsion orthosis without calf band
10
800
4 518 020 00 00 010
OB101-12
Torsion orthosis without calf band
12
1000
4 518 020 00 00 012
OB101-16
Torsion orthosis without calf band
16
1000
4 518 020 00 00 016
Pelvic Band
Order No.
Circumference
Article No.
OB102-45
40–45 cm
4 518 001 05 00 045
OB102-50
45–50 cm
4 518 001 05 00 050
OB102-55
50–55 cm
4 518 001 05 00 055
OB102-60
55–60 cm
4 518 001 05 00 060
OB102-65
60–65 cm
4 518 001 05 00 065
OB102-70
65–70 cm
4 518 001 05 00 070
OB102-75
70–75 cm
4 518 001 05 00 075
OB102-80
75–80 cm
4 518 001 05 00 080 119
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Features The torsion orthosis is a spring-rod fixed between a shoe attachment distally and a pelvic band proximally. An adjustable continuous torque is created to correct an existing rotational defect. The torsion rod connectors are made of aluminum, the rods are made from Vulkollan, a homogeneous elastomer. The calf band is made of leather. The rods can be pulled out of the connectors to enable length corrections of 20 mm on each end.
2.5 Hand Orthoses
Contraindication Pathological antetorsion of the femoral neck
2.6 Halswirbel-Orthetik
Indication Pathological internal tibial and foot rotation
2.3 Hip Orthoses
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Torsion Orthosis
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
2 Orthotics 2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Service Parts for Torsion Orthosis 6
4
9
13 10 11
12
14
7
15
5
2 3 1
8
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-OB01
Torsion rod, Ø 8 mm
4 518 001 01 00 008
1
E-OB02
Torsion rod, Ø 10 mm
4 518 001 01 00 010
1
E-OB03
Torsion rod, Ø 12 mm
4 518 001 01 00 012
1
E-OB04
Torsion rod, Ø 16 mm
4 518 001 01 00 016
1
E-OB05
Proximal attachment, straight w. connector, Ø 8 mm
4 518 001 02 00 008
2
E-OB06
Proximal attachment, straight, w. connector, Ø 10 mm
4 518 001 02 00 010
2
E-OB07
Proximal attachment, straight, w. connector, Ø 12 mm
4 518 001 02 00 012
2
E-OB08
Proximal attachment, straight, w. connector, Ø 16 mm
4 518 001 02 00 016
2
E-OB09
Distal attachment, curved, w. connector, Ø 8 mm
4 518 001 03 00 008
3
E-OB10
Distal attachment, curved, w. connector, Ø 10 mm
4 518 001 03 00 010
3
E-OB11
Distal attachment, curved, w. connector, Ø 12 mm
4 518 001 03 00 012
3
E-OB12
Distal attachment, curved, w. connector, Ø 16 mm
4 518 001 03 00 016
3
E-OB13
Shoe clamp
4 518 001 04 00 008
4
E-OB14
Torsion rod guide, Ø 8 mm
4 518 001 07 00 008
5
E-OB15
Torsion rod guide, Ø 10 mm
4 518 001 07 00 010
5
E-OB16
Torsion rod guide, Ø 12 mm
4 518 001 07 00 012
5
E-OB17
Torsion rod guide, Ø 16 mm
4 518 001 07 00 016
5
E-OB18
Torsion rod connector, Ø 8 mm
4 518 001 08 00 008
6
E-OB19
Torsion rod connector, Ø 10 mm
4 518 001 08 00 010
6
E-OB20
Torsion rod connector, Ø 12 mm
4 518 001 08 00 012
6
E-OB21
Torsion rod connector, Ø 16 mm
4 518 001 08 00 016
6
E-OB22
Proximal attachment, straight
4 518 001 09 00 000
7
E-OB23
Distal attachment, curved
4 518 001 10 00 000
8
E-OB24
Joint nut, M4
4 518 001 11 00 000
9
E-OB25
Joint screw M4
4 518 001 12 00 000
10
E-OB26
Washer
4 518 001 13 00 000
11
E-OB27
Hexagon socket screw M4 x 4
4 518 001 14 00 000
12
E-OB28
Joint screw, set
4 518 001 15 00 000
13
E-OB29
Buckle, 30 mm
4 518 001 16 00 000
14
E-OB30
Calf band compl. for torsion rod Ø 8 mm, circumference 15–20 cm
4 518 001 06 00 008
15
E-OB31
Calf band compl. for torsion rod Ø 10 mm, circumference 20–25 cm
4 518 001 06 00 010
15
E-OB32
Calf band compl. for torsion rod Ø 12 mm, circumference 20–25 cm
4 518 001 06 00 012
15
E-OB33
Calf band compl. for torsion rod Ø 16 mm, circumference 32.5–37.5 cm
4 518 001 06 00 016
15
E-OB34
Calf band compl. for torsion rod Ø 16 mm, circumference 30–35 cm
4 518 001 06 01 016
15
120
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
CoxaPort: Hip Orthoses for Postoperative Treatment.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.3 Hip Orthoses
The CoxaPort hip orthosis is designed for post-operative use on high-risk patients, and after revision surgery. The orthosis stabilizes the hip joint and limits its rotation.
2.3 Hip Orthoses
The modular construction makes it easy to custom-fit the orthosis to the patient‘s hip circumference and shape, making it more comfortable to wear.
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Overview of Technical Highlights:
2.5 Hand Orthoses
• Modular construction system • Easy to handle and adjust • Good skin tolerance • Multiaxial joint • Range of motion can be restricted • Very stable • Lightweight • Comfortable fit
!
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
The CoxaPort has the following components: • Hip harness • Hip pad • Thigh harness • Thigh pad • Joint
Please order all the different parts separately.
121
2 Orthotics 2.3 Hip Orthoses
Hip Sizing Diagram Waist circumference
Waist circumference in cm
Hip circumference
Size S
59–83 cm
Size S
67–91 cm
Size M
79–97 cm
Size M
89–111 cm
Size L
93–116 cm
Size L
105–127 cm
Size XL
99–120 cm
Size XL
111–131 cm
Hip circumference in cm
Thigh Sizing Diagram
Thigh circumference, proximal, in cm Thigh circumference, distal, in cm
1
1
Thigh circumferences proximal 43–54 cm
Size S
Size S
Size M
47–61 cm
Size M
35–46 cm
56–69 cm
Size L
41–50 cm
Size XL
62–76 cm
Size XL
46–56 cm
3
Hip harness
33–42 cm
Size L
2
Order No.
distal
2
4
Hip pads
Size
Side
Article No.
CPH-SL
S
left
4 503 010 10 70 022
CPHP-SL
CPH-ML
M
left
4 503 010 10 70 033
CPHP-ML
CPH-LL
L
left
4 503 010 10 70 044
CPHP-LL
L
left
4 503 010 11 70 044
CPH-XLL
XL
left
4 503 010 10 70 055
CPHP-XLL
XL
left
4 503 010 11 70 055
CPH-SR
S
right
4 503 010 20 70 022
CPHP-SR
S
right
4 503 010 21 70 022
CPH-MR
M
right
4 503 010 20 70 033
CPHP-MR
M
right
4 503 010 21 70 033
CPH-LR
L
right
4 503 010 20 70 044
CPHP-LR
L
right
4 503 010 21 70 044
CPH-XLR
XL
right
4 503 010 20 70 055
CPHP-XLR
XL
right
4 503 010 21 70 055
122
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
S
left
4 503 010 11 70 022
M
left
4 503 010 11 70 033
4
Thigh pads
Size
Side
Article No.
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
CP0-SL
S
left
4 503 010 10 80 022
CPOP-SL
S
left
4 503 010 10 00 022
CP0-ML
M
left
4 503 010 10 80 033
CPOP-ML
M
left
4 503 010 10 00 033
CP0-LL
L
left
4 503 010 10 80 044
CPOP-LL
L
left
4 503 010 10 00 044
CP0-XLL
XL
left
4 503 010 10 80 055
CPOP-XLL
XL
left
4 503 010 10 00 055
CP0-SR
S
right
4 503 010 20 80 022
CPOP-SR
S
right
4 503 010 21 10 022
CP0-MR
M
right
4 503 010 20 80 033
CPOP-MR
M
right
4 503 010 21 10 033
CP0-LR
L
right
4 503 010 20 80 044
CPOP-LR
L
right
4 503 010 21 10 044
CP0-XLR
XL
right
4 503 010 20 80 055
CPOP-XLR
XL
right
4 503 010 21 10 055
Patientâ&#x20AC;&#x2DC;s height:
Article No.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses 2.6 Cervical Orthoses
2.5 Hand Orthoses
Order No.
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Thigh harness
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
3
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
2 Orthotics 2.3 Hip Orthoses
Joint Order No.
Description
CPG-N
CoxaPort joint, normal
up to 180 cm
4 503 010 00 90 001
CPG-L
CoxaPort joint, long
> 180 cm
4 503 010 00 90 002
Service Parts Order No.
Description
Article No.
CPG-G
Belt, large (L, XL)
4 503 010 00 90 004
CPG-K
Belt, small (S, M)
4 503 010 00 90 005
CPG-GA
Joint cover
4 503 010 00 90 003
CPG-V
Bolt set (4 bolts, 1 hex wrench)
4 503 010 00 90 006 123
2 Orthotics 2.3 Hip Orthoses
124
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Three-point Support Brace Model 1 - for men
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Indication • Osteoporosis • After vertebral fractures • Severe kyphosis in the thoracic/lumbar area • Post-operative
Article No.
OR01-1
29–44 cm
26.5–32.5 cm
4 530 010 01 00 000
OR01-2
37–52 cm
30.5–36.5 cm
4 530 010 02 00 000
2.5 Hand Orthoses
min.–max. width
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
min.–max. length
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Features • Comfortable light aluminum frame • Movable and adjustable sternal pad • Padded, adjustable waist strap • Convenient anterior closure • Adjustable pubic pad • Easy to adjust using the Velcro closure strap
Order No.
Model 2 - for women Indication • Osteoporosis • After vertebral fractures • Severe kyphosis in the thoracic/lumbar area • Post-operative Features • Independently adjustable divided sternal pad (with Velcro attachment) • Comfortable light aluminum frame • Padded, adjustable waist strap • Convenient anterior closure • Adjustable pubic pad • Easy to adjust using the Velcro closure strap
Order No.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
min.–max. length
min.–max. width
Article No.
OR02-1
29–44 cm
26.5–32.5 cm
4 530 020 01 00 000
OR02-2
37–52 cm
30.5–36.5 cm
4 530 020 02 00 000 125
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Three-point Support Brace Model 3 - for woman, with adjustable chest pads Indication • Osteoporosis • After vertebral fractures • Severe kyphosis in the thoracic/lumbar area • Post-operative Features • Independently adjustable divided sternal pad (silicone attachment) • Comfortable light aluminum frame • Padded, adjustable waist strap • Convenient anterior closure • Adjustable pubic pad • Easy to adjust using the Velcro closure strap Order No.
min.–max. length
min.–max. width
Article No.
OR03-1
29–44 cm
26.5–32.5 cm
4 530 030 01 00 000
OR03-2
37–52 cm
30.5–36.5 cm
4 530 030 02 00 000
Service Parts for Three-point Support Brace, Models 1, 2 and 3 3
4
5
7
8
6 1 2
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-OR01
Roller ring with chafe and bar
4 530 001 01 00 000
1
E-OR02
Moveable pubic pad
4 530 001 02 00 000
2
E-OR03
Movable chest pad for Model 1
4 530 001 03 00 000
3
E-OR04
Chest pads with Velcro attachment for Model 2, 1 pair
4 530 001 04 00 001
4
E-OR05
Chest pads with silicone attachment for Model 3, 1 pair
4 530 001 04 00 002
5
E-OR06
Side pad with bar
4 530 001 04 00 003
6
E-OR07
Thoracolumbar pad, regular
4 530 001 08 00 001
7
E-OR08
Thoracolumbar pad, large
4 530 001 09 00 000
as 7
E-OR09
Waist strap, complete, long
4 530 001 10 00 000
8
126
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
BECKER Spinal Orthosis
Order No.
Description
Size
Article No.
OR04-S
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, standard
S
4 506 010 01 00 000
OR04-M
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, standard
M
4 506 010 02 00 000
OR04-L
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, standard
L
4 506 010 03 00 000
Order No.
Description
Size
Article No.
OR05-S
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, extra-wide
S
4 506 020 02 00 000
OR05-M
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, extra-wide
M
4 506 020 01 00 000
OR05-L
Hyperextension Orthosis with Thoracolumbar Pad, extra-wide
L
4 506 020 03 00 000
Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
Accessories for BECKER Hyperextension Orthosis 1
2
3
4
Description
E-OR10
Thoracolumbar Pad, standard
Size
Article No.
Pict.
4 506 001 02 00 000
1
E-OR11
Thoracolumbar Pad, extra-wide
4 506 001 01 00 000
1
E-OR12
Fastening straps for thoracolumbar pad
4 506 001 04 00 000
2
E-OR13
Closing pin for fixation strap
4 506 001 08 00 000
3
E-OR14
Button for fixation strap
4 506 001 09 00 000
4
E-OR15
Chest bar with pad
S
4 506 001 13 00 000
no pict.
E-OR16
Chest bar with pad
M
4 506 001 11 00 000
no pict.
E-OR17
Chest bar with pad
L
4 506 001 12 00 000
no pict.
E-OR18
Pubic bar with pad
S
4 506 001 16 00 000
no pict.
E-OR19
Pubic bar with pad
M
4 506 001 14 00 000
no pict.
E-OR20
Pubic bar with pad
L
4 506 001 15 00 000
no pict.
E-OR21
Side pad
M
4 506 001 17 00 022
no pict.
E-OR22
Mount for side pad
M
4 506 001 18 00 022
no pict. 127
2.5 Hand Orthoses
Biomechanics This orthosis has a frame construction which relieves the anterior edges of the vertebrae and prevents flexion and rotation while restricting the lateral movement in the lumbar and thoracolumbar areas.
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Features • Serrated joints allow the precise adjustment of the angular position of sternal and pubic pads in 5° increments. • Lateral uprights – length can be continuously adjusted, even for supine patients • Swiveling chest pads are more comfortable • Vertabral bodies are stabilized in hyperextension with various lumbar pads. • No plaster cast is required.
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Indication • Conservative treatment of vertebral compression fractures with stable posterior wall • Lumbar adolescent kyphosis with compensating thoracic hyperextension • After vertebral fractures • Post-op • Osteoporosis
Order No.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
BOSTON Spinal Orthosis Indication • Conservative treatment of painful segmental instability • Postoperative segment stabilization after fusion surgery • Preventative treatment for high-risk patients • Thoracic kyphosis in the middle to low thoracic spine area Features • Anatomically shaped body modules made of polyethelyene provide safe stabilization and support of pelvis, chest, and shoulders at several lordosis angles • Optional: Attachment of hyperextension bars to stabilize the shoulders • No plaster cast is required • Thermally and mechanically formable • Don and doff in a supine position with flexed knees. Biomechanics • Immobilization of the spinal segments in the lumbosacral and thoracolumbar areas. • Prevention of flexion, rotation, and lateral movements. • Safe immobilization is achieved through hyperextension bars.
for Men
for Women
Order No.
Size
Lordosis
Article No.
Order No.
Size
Lordosis
Article No.
BOB-1
1
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 001
BOB15-1D
1D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 001
BOB-2
2
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 002
BOB15-2D
2D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 002
BOB-3
3
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 003
BOB15-3D
3D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 003
BOB-4
4
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 004
BOB15-4D
4D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 004
BOB-5
5
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 005
BOB15-5D
5D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 005
BOB-6
6
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 006
BOB15-6D
6D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 006
BOB-7
7
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 007
BOB15-7D
7D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 007
BOB-8
8
0 degrees
4 502 010 00 00 008
BOB15-8D
8D
15 degrees
4 502 020 15 00 008
BOB15-1
1
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 001
BOB15-2
2
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 002
BOB15-3
3
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 003
BOB15-4
4
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 004
BOB15-5
5
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 005
BOB15-6
6
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 006
BOB15-7
7
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 007
BOB15-8
8
15 degrees
4 502 010 15 00 008
128
!
The hyperextension bars, closure straps and dorsal reinforcement stays must be ordered separately. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet Category).
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Accessories for BOSTON Spinal Orthosis
Length
Article No.
16 cm
4 502 001 03 00 006
18 cm
4 502 001 03 00 007
E-BOB03
21 cm
4 502 001 03 00 008
E-BOB04
24 cm
4 502 001 03 00 009
Order No.
Length
Article No.
E-BOB10
21 cm
4 502 001 04 00 021
E-BOB11
26 cm
4 502 001 04 00 026
E-BOB12
29 cm
4 502 001 04 00 029
E-BOB13
32 cm
4 502 001 04 00 032
E-BOB14
34 cm
4 502 001 04 00 034
E-BOB15
36 cm
4 502 001 04 00 036
E-BOB17
43 cm
4 502 001 04 00 016
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
E-BOB01 E-BOB02
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Closure Straps Order No.
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
2.5 Hand Orthoses
Dorsal Reinforcement Stays, pair
Hyperextension Bars, pair Size
Distance (center of rotation to top of pad)
Article No.
E-BOB20
M
20 cm
4 502 001 01 00 000
E-BOB21
L
21.5 cm
4 502 001 02 00 000
Order No.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
129
2 Orthotics 2.4 Spinal Orthoses
T-Shirts Short-sleeve T-shirt, for children and adults White, 96% cotton, 4% elasthan. The T-shirts are specially made to be used under the corsets. • Extra long • Narrow sleeve opening • Prevents wrinkling around the axilla so painful pressure spots are avoided • No side seam Order No.
Size
Article No.
OR10-098
98
4 237 010 00 00 098
OR10-104
104
4 237 010 00 00 104
OR10-110
110
4 237 010 00 00 110
OR10-116
116
4 237 010 00 00 116
OR10-122
122
4 237 010 00 00 122
OR10-128
128
4 237 010 00 00 128
OR10-134
134
4 237 010 00 00 134
OR10-140
140
4 237 010 00 00 140
OR10-146
146
4 237 010 00 00 146
OR10-152
152
4 237 010 00 00 152
OR10-158
158
4 237 010 00 00 158
OR10-164
164
4 237 010 00 00 164
OR10-176
176
4 237 010 00 00 176
OR10-S
S
4 237 020 01 00 000
OR10-M
M
4 237 020 02 00 000
OR10-L
L
4 237 020 03 00 000
OR10-XL
XL
4 237 020 04 00 000
OR10-XXL
XXL
4 237 020 05 00 000
Sleeveless T-shirt, for children and adults Material and design see Short-sleeve T-Shirt above.
130
Order No.
Size
Article No.
OR11-098
98
4 237 030 00 00 098
OR11-104
104
4 237 030 00 00 104
OR11-110
110
4 237 030 00 00 110
OR11-116
116
4 237 030 00 00 116
OR11-128
128
4 237 030 00 00 128
OR11-134
134
4 237 030 00 00 134
OR11-140
140
4 237 030 00 00 140
OR11-146
146
4 237 030 00 00 146
OR11-152
152
4 237 030 00 00 152
OR11-158
158
4 237 030 00 00 158
OR11-164
164
4 237 030 00 00 164
OR11-176
176
4 237 030 00 00 176
OR11-S
S
4 237 040 01 00 000
OR11-M
M
4 237 040 02 00 000
OR11-L
L
4 237 040 03 00 000
OR11-XL
XL
4 237 040 04 00 000
OR11-XXL
XXL
4 237 040 05 00 000
DAHO Hand Orthoses – For individualized treatment.
These modular orthoses are available in four different models according to the specific indication: MODEL 1 MODEL 2.X MODEL 3 MODEL 4.X
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
• RHEUMATISM ORTHOSIS • EXTENSION ORTHOSIS • FLEXION ORTHOSIS • RESTING SPLINT
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses 2.3 Hip Orthoses
A healthy hand is characterized by its flexibility, strength, sensitivity, and expressiveness. So it is an essential tool and sensory and and expression organ. The hand‘s ability to perform these functions may be compromised by illness or injury. The DAHO hand orthoses help restore the hand‘s natural mobility and, as a result, its functionality.
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
Features of all DAHO hand orthoses:
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
2.5 Hand Orthoses
• Modular construction • Good fit • Good skin tolerance • Lightweight • Adjustable and easy to handle • Permeable to X-rays • Basic material: polyethylene
131
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 1 Features • Conservative and post-operative treatment of rheumatoid arthritis • Improvement of gripping function and prevention of contractures • Before hand surgery for activation in cases of ulnar deviation • Maintenance of the position after soft tissue or prosthetic replacement surgery • Correction of hand deviations Features • Individual movement of digits • Maintains wrist movement • Prevention of contractures • Dynamic redression Biomechanics • Dynamic retention of the MP joints and correction of hand deviations. • Straightening of the four long digits in dorso-radial direction. • Realignment of the midhand in dorso-ulnar direction • Restoration of the anatomical palmar transverse arch.
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO1-SL
S
left
4 501 010 01 01 000
DAHO1-ML
M
left
4 501 010 01 02 000
DAHO1-LL
L
left
4 501 010 01 03 000
DAHO1-SR
S
right
4 501 010 02 01 000
DAHO1-MR
M
right
4 501 010 02 02 000
DAHO1-LR
L
right
4 501 010 02 03 000
132
!
2 extra rubber bands for finger loop (E-DAHO 28) inclusive. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category). Delivery includes one rigid and one flexible connection bar (E-DAHO 20/21 and E-DAHO 22).
Extension Unit, complete Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO10
S/M
left
4 501 011 01 01 000
E-DAHO11
L
left
4 501 011 01 02 000
E-DAHO12
S/M
right
4 501 011 02 01 000
E-DAHO13
L
right
4 501 011 02 02 000
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
Midhand Cuff
E-DAHO14
S
left
4 501 011 01 03 000
E-DAHO15
M
left
4 501 011 01 04 000
E-DAHO16
L
left
4 501 011 01 05 000
S
right
4 501 011 02 03 000
M
right
4 501 011 02 04 000
E-DAHO19
L
right
4 501 011 02 05 000
Order No.
Version
Article No.
Pict.
E-DAHO20
rigid, left
4 501 021 01 12 000
1
E-DAHO21
rigid, right
4 501 021 02 12 000
1
E-DAHO22
flexible, with spring, for left and right
4 501 011 00 07 000
2
Order No.
Version
Article No.
E-DAHO23
for left and right
4 501 011 00 08 000
Connection Bar, with screws
1
1
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses 2.6 Cervical Orthoses
E-DAHO17 E-DAHO18
2.5 Hand Orthoses
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Order No.
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Service Parts for DAHO Model 1
2.3 Hip Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
2
Forearm Cuff
133
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 2.1 Basic model with MP blocker und rigid wrist connector Indication For passive use of the orthosis • Extension and immobilization of the flexors of the fingers with a rigid wrist For active use of the orthosis • Strengthening the flexors and extension of the finger extensors • Prevention of contracture in case of lesions of the peripheral nervous system • Redression of soft tissue contractures with flexion deformities Features • Traction force adaptable to the joints • Maximum force effect on the movement of each finger Optional: dynamic thumb extensor Biomechanics This orthosis facilitates dynamic flexion of the DIP/PIP/MP joints to strengthen the flexors, and passive extension of the DIP/PIP/MP joints to stretch or immobilize the flexors with a rigid wrist. Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO21-SL
S
left
4 501 020 01 01 000
DAHO21-ML
M
left
4 501 020 01 02 000
DAHO21-LL
L
left
4 501 020 01 03 000
DAHO21-SR
S
right
4 501 020 02 01 000
DAHO21-MR
M
right
4 501 020 02 02 000
DAHO21-LR
L
right
4 501 020 02 03 000
!
2 extra rubber bands for finger loop (E-DAHO 28) included. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 2.2 Basic model without MP blocker and rigid wrist connector Indication See model 2.1 Features • Traction force adaptable to the joints • Maximum force effect on the movement of each finger Biomechanics See model 2.1
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO22-SL
S
left
4 501 030 01 01 000
DAHO22-ML
M
left
4 501 030 01 02 000
DAHO22-LL
L
left
4 501 030 01 03 000
DAHO22-SR
S
right
4 501 030 02 01 000
DAHO22-MR
M
right
4 501 030 02 02 000
DAHO22-LR
L
right
4 501 030 02 03 000
134
!
2 extra rubber bands for finger loop (E-DAHO 28) included. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
For active use of the orthosis • Strengthening the flexors and extension of the finger extensors and the wrist • Prevention of contracture in case of lesions of the peripheral nervous system • Redression of soft tissue contractures with flexion deformities Features • Traction force adaptable to the joints • Concentration of the extension forces on the DIP and PIP joints and on the wrist against the MP blocker Optional: dynamic thumb extensor
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO23-SL
S
left
4 501 040 01 01 000
DAHO23-ML
M
left
4 501 040 01 02 000
DAHO23-LL
L
left
4 501 040 01 03 000
DAHO23-SR
S
right
4 501 040 02 01 000
DAHO23-MR
M
right
4 501 040 02 02 000
DAHO23-LR
L
right
4 501 040 02 03 000
!
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Order No.
Biomechanics The orthosis facilitates dynamic flexion of the DIP/PIP/MPjoints to strengthen the flexors, as well as passive extension of the DIP/PIP/ MP joints to stretch or immobilize the flexors with a rigid MP joint and a flexible wrist.
2 extra rubber bands for finger loop (E-DAHO 28) included. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 2.4 Basic model without MP blocker and dynamic wrist spring Indication See model 2.3 Features • Traction force adaptable to the joints • Concentration of the extension forces on the DIP/PIP/MP joints Optional: dynamic thumb extensor Biomechanics See model 2.3 Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO24-SL
S
left
4 501 050 01 01 000
DAHO24-ML
M
left
4 501 050 01 02 000
DAHO24-LL
L
left
4 501 050 01 03 000
DAHO24-SR
S
right
4 501 050 02 01 000
DAHO24-MR
M
right
4 501 050 02 02 000
DAHO24-LR
L
right
4 501 050 02 03 000
!
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Indication For passive use of the orthosis • Extension and immobilization of the flexors of the fingers without a rigid wrist
2.5 Hand Orthoses
Basic model with MP blocker and dynamic wrist spring
2.3 Hip Orthoses
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 2.3
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
2 extra rubber bands for finger loop (E-DAHO 28) included. Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category). 135
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
Service Parts and Accessories for DAHO, Models 2.1â&#x20AC;&#x201C;2.4 Dynamic Thumb Extensor Order No.
Side
Article No.
DAHO-EXL
left
4 501 021 01 02 000
DAHO-EXR
right
4 501 021 02 02 000
Dynamic Extensor and Service Parts
1
Order No.
Description
Article No.
Pict.
E-DAHO24
Dynamic extensor, complete, for right and left
4 501 021 00 01 000
1
E-DAHO25
Coil spring
4 501 001 00 05 000
2
E-DAHO26
Slotted washer, M4 aluminum
4 501 001 00 14 000
3
E-DAHO27
Finger loop and rubber band
4 501 001 00 19 000
4
E-DAHO28
Rubber band for finger loop
4 501 001 00 08 000
5
2
3
4
5
MP blocker, incl. attachment bars Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO29
S/M
left
4 501 021 01 03 000
E-DAHO30
L
left
4 501 021 01 04 000
E-DAHO31
S/M
right
4 501 021 02 03 000
E-DAHO32
L
right
4 501 021 02 04 000
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO33
S/M
left
4 501 021 01 05 000
E-DAHO34
L
left
4 501 021 01 06 000
E-DAHO35
S/M
right
4 501 021 02 05 000
E-DAHO36
L
right
4 501 021 02 06 000
Dynamic Extensor with MP Blocker
136
Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO37
S
left
4 501 021 01 08 000
E-DAHO38
M
left
4 501 021 01 09 000
E-DAHO39
L
left
4 501 021 01 10 000
E-DAHO40
S
right
4 501 021 02 08 000
E-DAHO41
M
right
4 501 021 02 09 000
E-DAHO42
L
right
4 501 021 02 10 000
Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO43
for left and right
4 501 021 00 11 000
The coil springs for the wrist (Ă&#x2DC; = 1.9 mm) can be ordered separately. Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO44
left
4 501 011 01 06 000
E-DAHO45
right
4 501 011 02 06 000
Connection bar, incl. screws Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO20
rigid, left
4 501 021 01 12 000
E-DAHO21
rigid, right
4 501 021 02 12 000
Forearm Cuff Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO23
for left and right
4 501 011 00 08 000
137
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses 2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Wrist Coil Spring
2.5 Hand Orthoses
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Order No.
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Midhand Cuff
2.3 Hip Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 3 Indication Conservative and postoperative treatment after injuries to the extensor tendons • Redression of flexion deficits and soft tissue contractures • Strengthening of the finger extensors through applying dynamic flexion forces Features • Gentle application of force with minimal friction through a roller bar on the volar side of the orthosis • Fixation of the wrist • Maximum flexion of all finger joints Biomechanics The orthosis facilitates active extension of the DIP/PIP/MP joints to strengthen the finger extensors, as well as passive flexion of the DIP/PIP/MP joints to stretch or immobilize the finger extensors with a rigid wrist.
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO3-SL
S
left
4 501 070 01 01 000
DAHO3-ML
M
left
4 501 070 01 02 000
DAHO3-LL
L
left
4 501 070 01 03 000
DAHO3-SR
S
right
4 501 070 02 01 000
DAHO3-MR
M
right
4 501 070 02 02 000
DAHO3-LR
L
right
4 501 070 02 03 000
!
Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
Service Parts for DAHO Model 3 Midhand Cuff Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO37
S
left
4 501 021 01 08 000
E-DAHO38
M
left
4 501 021 01 09 000
E-DAHO39
L
left
4 501 021 01 10 000
E-DAHO40
S
right
4 501 021 02 08 000
E-DAHO41
M
right
4 501 021 02 09 000
E-DAHO42
L
right
4 501 021 02 10 000
Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO23
for left and right
4 501 011 00 08 000
Forearm Cuff
138
Flexion Unit incl. connection bar and holding stirrup Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-DAHO46
Connection bar, left
4 501 071 01 02 000
E-DAHO47
Connection bar, right
4 501 071 02 02 000
E-DAHO48
Holding stirrup, left/right
4 501 071 00 03 000
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses 2.3 Hip Orthoses
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO49
S/M
left
4 501 071 01 04 000
E-DAHO50
L
left
4 501 071 01 05 000
E-DAHO51
S/M
right
4 501 071 02 04 000
E-DAHO52
L
right
4 501 071 02 05 000
Roller Bar incl. Screw Order No.
Side
Article No.
E-DAHO53
left
4 501 071 01 01 000
E-DAHO54
right
4 501 071 02 01 000
139
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Glove with Rubber Bands
2.5 Hand Orthoses
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
! Parts must be ordered separately.
2 Orthotics 2.5 Hand Orthoses
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 4 Indication To immobilize the wrist, finger and thumb joints • Primary treatment, e. g., after burns • For acute pain • For physiological positioning after hand surgery Features • Anatomically functional positioning of the hand • Thermoformable reworking possibility
Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO4-SL
S
left
4 501 080 01 01 000
DAHO4-ML
M
left
4 501 080 01 02 000
DAHO4-LL
L
left
4 501 080 01 03 000
DAHO4-XLL
XL
left
4 501 080 01 04 000
DAHO4-SR
S
right
4 501 080 02 01 000
DAHO4-MR
M
right
4 501 080 02 02 000
DAHO4-LR
L
right
4 501 080 02 03 000
DAHO4-XLR
XL
right
4 501 080 02 04 000
!
Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
DAHO Hand Orthosis, Model 4 (perforated) Indication See model 4 Features • Anatomically functional positioning of the hand • Thermoformable reworking possibility • Air permeability due to perforations Order No.
Size
Side
Article No.
DAHO4P-SL
S
left
4 501 090 01 01 000
DAHO4P-ML
M
left
4 501 090 01 02 000
DAHO4P-LL
L
left
4 501 090 01 03 000
DAHO4P-SR
S
right
4 501 090 02 01 000
DAHO4P-MR
M
right
4 501 090 02 02 000
DAHO4P-LR
L
right
4 501 090 02 03 000
!
140
Place order using the measurement sheet (See Measurement Sheet category).
2.2 Lower Limb Orthoses (HKAFO)
Philadelphia Cervical Collar with Tracheotomy Opening
2.3 Hip Orthoses
Indication • Cervical syndrome • After neck injury • Dislocation in the neck area • Moderate or severe whiplash injury • Deterioration of the intervertebral disks • Postoperative stabilization after cervical vertebrae surgery
Size and Neck Circumference
Height*
Article No.
OH2-S06
S (25–31 cm)
6.0 cm (2 1/4“)
4 531 020 01 00 060
OH2-S08
S (25–31 cm)
8.0 cm (3 1/4“)
4 531 020 01 00 080
OH2-S10
S (25–31 cm)
10.5 cm (4 1/4“)
4 531 020 01 00 105
OH2-S13
S (25–31 cm)
13.0 cm (5 1/4“)
4 531 020 01 00 130
OH2-M06
M (32–39 cm)
6.0 cm (2 1/4“)
4 531 020 02 00 060
OH2-M08
M (32–39 cm)
8.0 cm (3 1/4“)
4 531 020 02 00 080
OH2-M10
M (32–39 cm)
10.5 cm (4 1/4“)
4 531 020 02 00 105
OH2-M13
M (32–39 cm)
13.0 cm (5 1/4“)
4 531 020 02 00 130
OH2-L06
L (40–45 cm)
6.0 cm (2 1/4“)
4 531 020 03 00 060
OH2-L08
L (40–45 cm)
8.0 cm (3 1/4“)
4 531 020 03 00 080
OH2-L10
L (40–45 cm)
10.5 cm (4 1/4“)
4 531 020 03 00 105
OH2-L13
L (40–45 cm)
13.0 cm (5 1/4“)
4 531 020 03 00 130
* measure vertically from tip of the chin to sternum
Accessories
Description
Article No.
E-OH1
Stabilizer, for all sizes
4 531 021 01 00 000 141
2.6 Cervical Orthoses
Order No.
2.5 Hand Orthoses
2.4 Spinal Orthoses
Features • Consists of two half-shells made of thermoformable Plastazote • Held together with hook-and-loop fastening straps. • with tracheotomy opening
Order No.
2.1 Ankle and Foot Orthoses
2 Orthotics 2.6 Cervical Orthoses
2 Orthoses 2.6 Cervical Orthoses
142
unique prosthetic solutions
3 Materials 3.1
Plaster Fabrication Materials
3.2
Lamination Materials
3.3
Plastic Sheet Materials
3.4
Padding Materials
3.5
Other Materials
3.6
Tools
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
2
5 1
3
1
4
CellonaÂŽ Plaster Bandages
Length: 2 m, high quality, fast-setting
4
Grease Pencil
Marks the skin when making the plaster impression.
Order No.
Width / cm
Pieces /delivery unit
Article No.
Order No.
Color
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM100-10
10
10
4 201 010 00 00 100
MM104-2
red
12
4 201 090 00 94 000
MM100-12
12
10
4 201 010 00 00 120
MM100-15
15
10
4 201 010 00 00 150
MM100-20
20
10
4 201 010 00 00 200
2
Ruhrstern Elastic Plaster Bandages
Length: 2 m, unstretched, fast-setting
5
Indelible Pencil
Marks on wet plaster moulds and plaster casts.
Order No.
Width in cm
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
Order No.
Color
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM101-10
10
10
4 201 020 00 00 100
MM105
blue
12
4 201 100 93 00 000
MM101-12
12
10
4 201 020 00 00 120
MM101-15
15
10
4 201 020 00 00 150
MM101-35
35
10
4 201 020 00 00 350
3
Vermiculite
Plaster filler for weight reduction Order No.
Grain in mm
Liters/delivery unit
Article No.
MM102-2
0â&#x20AC;&#x201C;2
100
4 201 060 02 00 100
144
1
Plaster Parting Agent Cream
3
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.5 Other Materials
3
2
Alginate
This Plaster Parting Agent Cream is non-irritating, does not smear, drip or stick. A uniform separating film is formed when applied on the skin. Marks made with a grease or indelible pencil can be clearly transferred to the negative plaster cast.
Copying paste to make impressions of prosthetic sockets and residual limbs (eudermic) Setting time 4 minutes Mixing ratio, water/ alginate = 4:1
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MM107
1
4 201 110 00 00 100
MM114
6
4 201 180 00 00 600
2
Carbon Sanding Sheet
Made of carbon, 280 x 115 mm Order No.
Grain
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM111
120
10
4 201 150 01 00 000
145
3.6 Tools
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
AK Portable Brim Stand The AK Portable Brim Stand is a universally applicable weight supporting unit for transfemoral applications. The system is light and portable and thus a practical device for ambulatory fittings.
2
4
3
5
6
1
7
Applications: • As a fitting stand for transfemoral trial or final sockets • For immediate postoperative use to allow standing • Very stable – no knee joint or forefoot lever • Simple and individual length adjustability • Alignment possibility through a pyramid adaptor
AK Portable Brim Stand, complete The complete system can be used as a socket holding device or to secure the transfemoral brims utilizing the provided attachment bars. In some cases plaster impressions can be taken. Order No.
Article No.
Pict.
MM200-1
4 302 010 00 00 000
1
Spare Parts Order No.
Description
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
Pict.
E-MM01
Spacer for AK Portable Brim Stand, to increase brim-holding bars distance
1
4 302 011 01 00 000
2
E-MM02
Countersunk screw M8 x 45, to secure the spacer to the holding bars
1
4 302 011 02 00 000
3
E-MM03
Cap screw M5 x 8, attachment of holding bars stand to the transfemoral measuring system
10
4 302 011 03 00 000
4
E-MM04
Set of countersunk screws M5 x 8, to mount the brim
12
4 302 011 04 00 000
5
E-MM05
Set on the AK Portable Brim Stand
Set
4 302 011 05 00 000
6
E-MM06
Round support base
1
4 302 010 00 00 001
7
! Casting Brims must be ordered separately. 146
3.2 Lamination Materials
AK Casting Brims
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
Circumference in cm Side
Article No.
MM221-28L
28
left
4 304 080 01 00 028
MM221-30L
30
left
4 304 080 01 00 030
MM221-32L
32
left
4 304 080 01 00 032
MM221-34L
34
left
4 304 080 01 00 034
AK Casting Brims, version: CASCD
MM221-36L
36
left
4 304 080 01 00 036
MM221-38L
38
left
4 304 080 01 00 038
These brims have holes on the sides for the fixation on the AK Portable Brim Stand. This technique facilitates secure fixation of the brims for measurement of the residual limb or for the casting procedure.
MM221-40L
40
left
4 304 080 01 00 040
MM221-42L
42
left
4 304 080 01 00 042
MM221-44L
44
left
4 304 080 01 00 044
MM221-46L
46
left
4 304 080 01 00 046
MM221-48L
48
left
4 304 080 01 00 048
MM221-50L
50
left
4 304 080 01 00 050
! Circumference is measured just below the ischial tuberosity.
Soft (quadrilateral)
MM221-52L
52
left
4 304 080 01 00 052
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Side
Article No.
MM221-54L
54
left
4 304 080 01 00 054
MM220-42L
42
left
4 304 070 01 00 042
MM221-56L
56
left
4 304 080 01 00 056
MM220-44L
44
left
4 304 070 01 00 044
MM221-28R
28
right
4 304 080 02 00 028
MM220-46L
46
left
4 304 070 01 00 046
MM221-30R
30
right
4 304 080 02 00 030
MM220-48L
48
left
4 304 070 01 00 048
MM221-32R
32
right
4 304 080 02 00 032
MM220-50L
50
left
4 304 070 01 00 050
MM221-34R
34
right
4 304 080 02 00 034
MM220-52L
52
left
4 304 070 01 00 052
MM221-36R
36
right
4 304 080 02 00 036
MM220-54L
54
left
4 304 070 01 00 054
MM221-38R
38
right
4 304 080 02 00 038
MM220-56L
56
left
4 304 070 01 00 056
MM221-40R
40
right
4 304 080 02 00 040
MM220-42R
42
right
4 304 070 02 00 042
MM221-42R
42
right
4 304 080 02 00 042
MM220-44R
44
right
4 304 070 02 00 044
MM221-44R
44
right
4 304 080 02 00 044
MM220-46R
46
right
4 304 070 02 00 046
MM221-46R
46
right
4 304 080 02 00 046
MM220-48R
48
right
4 304 070 02 00 048
MM221-48R
48
right
4 304 080 02 00 048
MM220-50R
50
right
4 304 070 02 00 050
MM221-50R
50
right
4 304 080 02 00 050
MM220-52R
52
right
4 304 070 02 00 052
MM221-52R
52
right
4 304 080 02 00 052
MM220-54R
54
right
4 304 070 02 00 054
MM221-54R
54
right
4 304 080 02 00 054
MM220-56R
56
right
4 304 070 02 00 056
MM221-56R
56
right
4 304 080 02 00 056
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see above)
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see above)
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM220
16
4 304 070 03 00 000
MM221
30
4 304 080 03 00 000 147
3.5 Other Materials
Order No.
3.6 Tools
Hard (quadrilateral)
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
The AK Casting Brims are available in two versions. The brims of the CASCD version have sockets on the sides for fixation in the transfemoral AK system and are made of a thicker material than the â&#x20AC;&#x17E;plaster modelâ&#x20AC;&#x153; version.
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
AK Casting Brims AK Casting Brims, version: CASCD CNC (quadrilateral)
Ischial Containment (modified quad/IC)
Order No.
Circumference in cm Side
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm Side
Article No.
MM222-36L
36
4 304 090 01 00 036
MM223-36L
36
left
4 304 100 01 00 036
left
MM222-38L
38
left
4 304 090 01 00 038
MM223-37L
37
left
4 304 100 01 00 037
MM222-40L
40
left
4 304 090 01 00 040
MM223-38L
38
left
4 304 100 01 00 038
MM222-42L
42
left
4 304 090 01 00 042
MM223-39L
39
left
4 304 100 01 00 039
MM222-44L
44
left
4 304 090 01 00 044
MM223-40L
40
left
4 304 100 01 00 040
MM222-46L
46
left
4 304 090 01 00 046
MM223-41L
41
left
4 304 100 01 00 041
MM222-48L
48
left
4 304 090 01 00 048
MM223-42L
42
left
4 304 100 01 00 042
MM222-50L
50
left
4 304 090 01 00 050
MM223-43L
43
left
4 304 100 01 00 043
MM222-52L
52
left
4 304 090 01 00 052
MM223-44L
44
left
4 304 100 01 00 044
MM222-54L
54
left
4 304 090 01 00 054
MM223-45L
45
left
4 304 100 01 00 045
MM222-56L
56
left
4 304 090 01 00 056
MM223-46L
46
left
4 304 100 01 00 046
MM222-58L
58
left
4 304 090 01 00 058
MM223-47L
47
left
4 304 100 01 00 047
MM222-60L
60
left
4 304 090 01 00 060
MM223-48L
48
left
4 304 100 01 00 048
MM222-62L
62
left
4 304 090 01 00 062
MM223-49L
49
left
4 304 100 01 00 049
MM222-64L
64
left
4 304 090 01 00 064
MM223-50L
50
left
4 304 100 01 00 050
MM222-36R
36
right
4 304 090 02 00 036
MM223-52L
52
left
4 304 100 01 00 052
MM222-38R
38
right
4 304 090 02 00 038
MM223-54L
54
left
4 304 100 01 00 054
MM222-40R
40
right
4 304 090 02 00 040
MM223-56L
56
left
4 304 100 01 00 056
MM222-42R
42
right
4 304 090 02 00 042
MM223-58L
58
left
4 304 100 01 00 058
MM222-44R
44
right
4 304 090 02 00 044
MM223-60L
60
left
4 304 100 01 00 060
MM222-46R
46
right
4 304 090 02 00 046
MM223-62L
62
left
4 304 100 01 00 062
MM222-48R
48
right
4 304 090 02 00 048
MM223-64L
64
left
4 304 100 01 00 064
MM222-50R
50
right
4 304 090 02 00 050
MM223-36R
36
right
4 304 100 02 00 036
MM222-52R
52
right
4 304 090 02 00 052
MM223-37R
37
right
4 304 100 02 00 037
MM222-54R
54
right
4 304 090 02 00 054
MM223-38R
38
right
4 304 100 02 00 038
MM222-56R
56
right
4 304 090 02 00 056
MM223-39R
39
right
4 304 100 02 00 039
MM222-58R
58
right
4 304 090 02 00 058
MM223-40R
40
right
4 304 100 02 00 040
MM222-60R
60
right
4 304 090 02 00 060
MM223-41R
41
right
4 304 100 02 00 041
MM222-62R
62
right
4 304 090 02 00 062
MM223-42R
42
right
4 304 100 02 00 042
MM222-64R
64
right
4 304 090 02 00 064
MM223-43R
43
right
4 304 100 02 00 043
MM223-44R
44
right
4 304 100 02 00 044
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see above)
MM223-45R
45
right
4 304 100 02 00 045
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM223-46R
46
right
4 304 100 02 00 046
MM222
30
4 304 090 03 00 000
MM223-47R
47
right
4 304 100 02 00 047
MM223-48R
48
right
4 304 100 02 00 048
MM223-49R
49
right
4 304 100 02 00 049
MM223-50R
50
right
4 304 100 02 00 050
MM223-52R
52
right
4 304 100 02 00 052
MM223-54R
54
right
4 304 100 02 00 054
MM223-56R
56
right
4 304 100 02 00 056
MM223-58R
58
right
4 304 100 02 00 058
MM223-60R
60
right
4 304 100 02 00 060
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see right) Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM223-62R
62
right
4 304 100 02 00 062
MM223
44
4 304 100 03 00 000
MM223-64R
64
right
4 304 100 02 00 064
148
AK Casting Brims The AK Casting Brims are available in two versions. The brims of the CASCD* version have holding pockets on the sides and are made of a thicker material than the â&#x20AC;&#x17E;plaster modelâ&#x20AC;&#x153; version. Circumference is measured just below the ischial tuberosity.
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
!
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
1
1
3.5 Other Materials
2
AK Casting Brims, version: plaster model
Soft (quadrilateral)
3.6 Tools
The AK casting brims, plaster model version, are held on the patient with a securing strap (transfemoral harness). The plaster bandage is wrapped around the end of the brim and around the distal end of the residual limb as well.
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see left)
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Side
Article No.
Order No.
Pieces/ delivery unit
Article No.
MM210-42L
42
left
4 304 030 01 00 042
MM210
16
4 304 030 03 00 000
MM210-44L
44
left
4 304 030 01 00 044
MM210-46L
46
left
4 304 030 01 00 046
MM210-48L
48
left
4 304 030 01 00 048
MM210-50L
50
left
4 304 030 01 00 050
MM210-52L
52
left
4 304 030 01 00 052
MM210-54L
54
left
4 304 030 01 00 054
MM210-56L
56
left
4 304 030 01 00 056
MM210-42R
42
right
4 304 030 02 00 042
MM210-44R
44
right
4 304 030 02 00 044
MM210-46R
46
right
4 304 030 02 00 046
MM210-48R
48
right
4 304 030 02 00 048
MM210-50R
50
right
4 304 030 02 00 050
MM210-52R
52
right
4 304 030 02 00 052
MM210-54R
54
right
4 304 030 02 00 054
Order No.
Article No.
MM210-56R
56
right
4 304 030 02 00 056
MM214
4 304 031 00 00 000
Transfemoral Harness
2
Transfemoral Harness
* CASCD = Computer Aided Socket and Cover Design 149
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
AK Casting Brims AK Casting Brims, version: plaster model CNC* (quadrilateral)
Hard (quadrilateral) Order No.
Circumference Side in cm
Article No.
Order No.
Circumference in cm
Side
Article No.
MM211-28L
28
left
4 304 040 01 00 028
MM212-36L
36
left
4 304 050 01 00 036
MM211-30L
30
left
4 304 040 01 00 030
MM212-38L
38
left
4 304 050 01 00 038
MM211-32L
32
left
4 304 040 01 00 032
MM212-40L
40
left
4 304 050 01 00 040
MM211-34L
34
left
4 304 040 01 00 034
MM212-42L
42
left
4 304 050 01 00 042
MM211-36L
36
left
4 304 040 01 00 036
MM212-44L
44
left
4 304 050 01 00 044
MM211-38L
38
left
4 304 040 01 00 038
MM212-46L
46
left
4 304 050 01 00 046
MM211-40L
40
left
4 304 040 01 00 040
MM212-48L
48
left
4 304 050 01 00 048
MM211-42L
42
left
4 304 040 01 00 042
MM210-50L
50
left
4 304 050 01 00 050
MM211-44L
44
left
4 304 040 01 00 044
MM212-52L
52
left
4 304 050 01 00 052
MM211-46L
46
left
4 304 040 01 00 046
MM212-54L
54
left
4 304 050 01 00 054
MM211-48L
48
left
4 304 040 01 00 048
MM212-56L
56
left
4 304 050 01 00 056
MM211-50L
50
left
4 304 040 01 00 050
MM212-58L
58
left
4 304 050 01 00 058
MM211-52L
52
left
4 304 040 01 00 052
MM212-60L
60
left
4 304 050 01 00 060
MM211-54L
54
left
4 304 040 01 00 054
MM212-62L
62
left
4 304 050 01 00 062
MM211-56L
56
left
4 304 040 01 00 056
MM212-64L
64
left
4 304 050 01 00 064
MM211-28R
28
right
4 304 040 02 00 028
MM212-36R
36
right
4 304 050 02 00 036
MM211-30R
30
right
4 304 040 02 00 030
MM212-38R
38
right
4 304 050 02 00 038
MM211-32R
32
right
4 304 040 02 00 032
MM212-40R
40
right
4 304 050 02 00 040
MM211-34R
34
right
4 304 040 02 00 034
MM212-42R
42
right
4 304 050 02 00 042
MM211-36R
36
right
4 304 040 02 00 036
MM212-44R
44
right
4 304 050 02 00 044
MM211-38R
38
right
4 304 040 02 00 038
MM212-46R
46
right
4 304 050 02 00 046
MM211-40R
40
right
4 304 040 02 00 040
MM212-48R
48
right
4 304 050 02 00 048
MM211-42R
42
right
4 304 040 02 00 042
MM212-50R
50
right
4 304 050 02 00 050
MM211-44R
44
right
4 304 040 02 00 044
MM212-52R
52
right
4 304 050 02 00 052
MM211-46R
46
right
4 304 040 02 00 046
MM212-54R
54
right
4 304 050 02 00 054
MM211-48R
48
right
4 304 040 02 00 048
MM212-56R
56
right
4 304 050 02 00 056
MM211-50R
50
right
4 304 040 02 00 050
MM212-58R
58
right
4 304 050 02 00 058
MM211-52R
52
right
4 304 040 02 00 052
MM212-60R
60
right
4 304 050 02 00 060
MM211-54R
54
right
4 304 040 02 00 054
MM212-62R
62
right
4 304 050 02 00 062
MM211-56R
56
right
4 304 040 02 00 056
MM212-64R
64
right
4 304 050 02 00 064
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see above)
Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see above)
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM211
30
4 304 040 03 00 000
MM212
30
4 304 050 03 00 000
* CNC = Computer Numerical Control/computer-controlled manufacturing machine 150
AK Casting Brims, version: plaster model Set includes 1 brim of each size and side (see left)
Order No.
Circumference in cm Side
Article No.
Order No.
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MM213-36L
36
left
4 304 060 01 00 036
MM213
44
4 304 060 03 00 000
MM213-37L
37
left
4 304 060 01 00 037
MM213-38L
38
left
4 304 060 01 00 038
MM213-39L
39
left
4 304 060 01 00 039
MM213-40L
40
left
4 304 060 01 00 040
MM213-41L
41
left
4 304 060 01 00 041
MM213-42L
42
left
4 304 060 01 00 042
MM213-43L
43
left
4 304 060 01 00 043
MM213-44L
44
left
4 304 060 01 00 044
MM213-45L
45
left
4 304 060 01 00 045
MM213-46L
46
left
4 304 060 01 00 046
MM213-47L
47
left
4 304 060 01 00 047
MM213-48L
48
left
4 304 060 01 00 048
MM213-49L
49
left
4 304 060 01 00 049
MM213-50L
50
left
4 304 060 01 00 050
MM213-52L
52
left
4 304 060 01 00 052
MM213-54L
54
left
4 304 060 01 00 054
MM213-56L
56
left
4 304 060 01 00 056
MM213-58L
58
left
4 304 060 01 00 058
MM213-60L
60
left
4 304 060 01 00 060
MM213-62L
62
left
4 304 060 01 00 062
MM213-64L
64
left
4 304 060 01 00 064
MM213-36R
36
right
4 304 060 02 00 036
MM213-37R
37
right
4 304 060 02 00 037
MM213-38R
38
right
4 304 060 02 00 038
MM213-39R
39
right
4 304 060 02 00 039
MM213-40R
40
right
4 304 060 02 00 040
MM213-41R
41
right
4 304 060 02 00 041
MM213-42R
42
right
4 304 060 02 00 042
MM213-43R
43
right
4 304 060 02 00 043
MM213-44R
44
right
4 304 060 02 00 044
MM213-45R
45
right
4 304 060 02 00 045
MM213-46R
46
right
4 304 060 02 00 046
MM213-47R
47
right
4 304 060 02 00 047
MM213-48R
48
right
4 304 060 02 00 048
MM213-49R
49
right
4 304 060 02 00 049
MM213-50R
50
right
4 304 060 02 00 050
MM213-52R
52
right
4 304 060 02 00 052
MM213-54R
54
right
4 304 060 02 00 054
MM213-56R
56
right
4 304 060 02 00 056
MM213-58R
58
right
4 304 060 02 00 058
MM213-60R
60
right
4 304 060 02 00 060
MM213-62R
62
right
4 304 060 02 00 062
MM213-64R
64
right
4 304 060 02 00 064
3.6 Tools
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
Ischial Containment (modified quad/IC)
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
AK Casting Brims
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
151
3 Materials 3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
152
3.2 Lamination Materials
Rigid Foam and Hardener
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
3
Orthopur Rigid Foam 200
4
4
3.5 Other Materials
1
2
Hardener for Rigid Foam
Volume increase approx. 6.5; for normal loads. Mixing ratio, rigid foam/hardener = 1:1
Suitable for all types of rigid foams
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG100-0.9
0,865
4 202 010 20 00 090
MG104-0.9
0,865
4 202 020 00 00 090
MG100-4.6
4,6
4 202 010 20 00 460
MG104-4.6
4,6
4 202 020 00 00 460
2
Orthopur Rigid Foam 300
5
Polyethylene Sheets
Volume increase approx. 4.7; for heavy loads. Mixing ratio, rigid foam/hardener = 1:1
Wrapping material for socket foam extension
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
Order No.
Plate size in mm
Article No.
MG101-0.9
0,865
4 202 010 30 00 090
MG105-1
1000 x 1000 x 1
4 202 060 00 00 001
MG101-4.6
4,6
4 202 010 30 00 460
MG105-2
1000 x 1000 x 2
4 202 060 00 00 002
3
Orthopur Rigid Foam 700
Volume increase approx. 1.7; e.g., for shoe lasts, can be screwed and nailed. Mixing ratio, rigid foam/hardener = 10:7 Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG100-0.9
0,865
4 202 010 70 00 090
MG100-4.6
4,6
4 202 010 70 00 460
5
Irritant
Flammable 153
3.6 Tools
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
Rigid foams are two-component foams with a wide range of applications in prosthetics and orthotics as well as in the fabrication of orthopedic shoes.
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Silicones & Accessories
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
ipocon® 7 Components 100% pure silicone, viscous liquid, , dermatologically safe, shore hardness variable depending on the mixing ratio of the two components, Applications: prosthetic soft liners, distal end pads • avoid contact with talcum powder (inhibits curing) • pot life at room temperature: approx. 120 minutes (component B) or approx. 30 minutes (component B „quick“) Order No.
Description
Content / kg
Article No.
Pict.
MG106
Silicone, component A, skin-colored
2
4 220 010 01 00 020
1
MG108-1
Component B
0,2
4 220 010 02 00 002
4
MG108-2
Silicone, component B „quick“
0,2
4 220 010 03 00 002
3
Mixing ratio A/B = 4:1 (soft) to A/ B = 8:1 (hard)
ipocon® 7 Body Paste Paste-like, dermatologically safe, variable shore hardness depending on the mixing ratio of the two components, no parting agent needed, pot life as noted above, Applications: foot orthotics, toe correction, spacer after toe amputations, distal end pads Order No.
Description
Content / kg
Article No.
Pict.
MG107
Body Paste, comp. A, skin-colored
0,5
4 220 030 00 00 050
2
MG108-1
Component B, colorless
0,2
4 220 010 02 00 002
4
MG108-2
Silicone, component B „quick“, colorless
0,2
4 220 010 03 00 002
3
Mixing ratio A/B = 4: 1 (soft) to A/ B = 8: 1 (hard)
ipocon® 7 Duplicating Paste viscoelastic, dermatologically safe, Applications: foot orthoses, toe correction, spacer after toe amputations, distal end pads Order No.
Description
Content / kg
Article No.
Pict.
MG109
Duplicating Paste A, gray
0,3
4 220 020 00 00 125
5
MG110
Duplicating Paste B20, white
0,3
4 220 020 00 00 225
6
MG111
Duplicating Paste B45, skin-colored
0,3
4 220 020 40 00 325
7
Mixing ratio A/B = 1:1
154
Acrylic Resins
Laminating Resin 80:20
4
for rigid laminates Order No.
Content / kg
Laminating and Sealing Resin
Article No.
for rigid laminates 0.5 to 1.0% hardener powder, for sealing resin use 3% hardener powder. Allergy risk is reduced due to utilizing less hardener.
MG112-0.9
0,9
4 204 010 02 00 009
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG112-4.6
4,6
4 204 010 02 00 046
MG115-4.6
4,6
4 204 010 01 00 046
MG112-25
25
4 204 010 02 00 250
MG115-25
25
4 204 010 01 00 250
2
Carbon Acrylic Resin
5
for rigid laminates and carbon fiber technique Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG113-0.9
0,9
4 204 020 02 00 009
â&#x20AC;&#x17E;Elasticâ&#x20AC;&#x153; Laminating Resin
for flexible laminates Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG113-4.6
4,6
4 204 020 02 00 046
MG116-0.9
0,9
4 204 050 02 00 009
MG113-25
25
4 204 020 02 00 250
MG116-4.6
4,6
4 204 050 02 00 046
3
Sealing Resin
for strengthening, sealing and bonding Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG114-0.9
0,9
4 204 030 02 00 009
MG114-4.6
4,6
4 204 030 02 00 046
MG114-25
25
4 204 030 02 00 250
!
25 kg barrel is delivered in square containers.
Irritant
Flammable 155
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.6 Tools
1
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
Acrylic resins are two-component methyl-methacrylate resins. The resulting laminates are non-irritating to the skin and thermoplastically formable foams with a wide range of applications in prosthetics and orthotics as well as in the fabrication of orthopedic shoes.
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
1
2
1
3
Hardener Paste
for Acrylic and Polyester Resins Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG119-0.2
0,2
4 205 010 00 00 200
MG119-0.5
0,5
4 205 010 00 00 500
2
Hardener Powder
for Acrylic and Polyester Resins Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG120-0.15
0,15
4 205 020 01 00 150
MG120-0.5
0,5
4 205 020 01 00 500
3
Epoxy Resin
(Carbon Epoxy Acrylic Resin) for laminates with high strength and thin walls. Delivered with hardener paste. Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG121
3,8
4 206 010 00 00 038
Irritant 156
Flammable
Oxidizing
Color Paste
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Materials for Silicone- and Lamination workings
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
for all types of laminating resins and silicones Order No.
Color
Content / ml
Article No.
MG125-H1
skin-colored
250
4 207 011 00 91 250
MG125-H2
skin-colored
500
4 207 011 00 91 500
MG125-BR
brown
250
4 207 011 00 95 250
MG125-W
white
250
4 207 011 00 89 250
MG125-G
yellow
250
4 207 011 00 87 250
MG125-B
blue
250
4 207 011 00 93 250
MG125-R
red
250
4 207 011 00 94 250
MG125-S
black
250
4 207 011 00 92 250
3.6 Tools
Easy and precise proportioning of the color is possible due to the new closure with the patented protection membrane.
Advantages: • Clean and drip-free dispensing • Onehanded and direct dispensing • Pressure valve for adjustable flow control • Space-saving upside-down packaging • User-friendly and precise • Color paste will not dry out
Irritant 157
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Materials for Lamination and Silicone Technique
1
1
2
3
Microballoon
3
White, filler for laminating resins, improved grindability and flexural strength Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG126
1
4 207 020 00 00 001
2
Talcum Powder
Wooden Spatula
Beech wood, without marks Order No.
Length in mm
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MG129-1
150
100
4 207 040 00 01 150
MG129-2
250
100
4 207 040 00 01 250
4
Extender, to powder patterns
Measuring Cup
Polypropylene, with graduation
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG127
1
4 207 030 00 00 000
158
4
Order No.
Contents in ml
Pieces/delivery unit
Article No.
MG131-200
200
100
4 207 060 01 00 200
MG131-400
400
100
4 207 060 01 00 400
3.2 Lamination Materials
PVA-Films and Accessories
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
2
C 3
A 4
Thickness: 0,10 mm, delivery unit: 10 pcs. 1
1
PVA Sleeves (machine-sealed)
Thickness: 0,08 mm, delivery unit: 10 pcs.
Order No.
Dimensions / mm AxBxC
Article No.
MG142-1
100 x 10 x 5
4 208 020 01 10 100
MG142-2
100 x 15 x 5
4 208 020 02 10 100
MG142-3
100 x 20 x 5
4 208 020 03 10 100
MG142-4
100 x 25 x 5
4 208 020 04 10 100
MG142-5
100 x 30 x 5
4 208 020 05 10 100
MG142-6
100 x 35 x 5
4 208 020 06 10 100
Order No.
Dimensions / mm AxBxC
Article No.
MG140-01
77 x 11 x 5
4 208 020 01 08 077
MG140-02
77 x 19 x 5
4 208 020 02 08 077
MG140-03
77 x 22 x 5
4 208 020 04 08 077
30 m roll
MG140-04
77 x 27 x 5
4 208 020 03 08 077
Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
MG143-1
1300
4 208 010 00 08 130
MG140-05
100 x 10 x 5
4 208 020 01 08 100
MG140-06
100 x 15 x 5
4 208 020 02 08 100
MG140-07
100 x 20 x 5
4 208 020 03 08 100
MG140-08
100 x 25 x 5
4 208 020 04 08 100
for sealing PVA films
MG140-09
100 x 30 x 5
4 208 020 05 08 100
Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
MG140-10
100 x 35 x 5
4 208 020 06 08 100
MG144
25
4 208 050 00 00 000
MG140-11
130 x 22 x 5
4 208 020 01 08 130
MG140-12
130 x 26 x 5
4 208 020 02 08 130
MG140-13
130 x 30 x 5
4 208 020 03 08 130
Thickness: 0,08 mm, delivery unit: 20 pcs.
PVA film
3.6 Tools
2
Thickness: 0,08 mm
Polyethylene Adhesive Tape
3
4
Double-Faced PVC Adhesive Tape
55 m roll Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
MG151-09
9
4 209 030 00 00 009
MG151-19
19
4 209 030 00 00 019
Order No.
Dimensions / mm AxBxC
Article No.
MG141-1
100 x 10 x 5
4 208 040 00 08 004
MG141-2
100 x 15 x 5
4 208 040 00 08 006
PVC adhesive tape
MG141-3
100 x 20 x 5
4 208 040 00 08 008
Order No.
100 x 25 x 5
4 208 040 00 08 010
Width in mm
Length in m
Article No.
MG141-4 MG141-5
100 x 30 x 5
4 208 040 00 08 012
MG152
50
10
4 209 040 00 00 000
5
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
B
5
Coroplast
159
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Accessories for Hard Foam, Silicone and Lamination Technique
2
1
3 4
1
Elastic Tape
3
Length: 0,5 m, made of Vulcollan速, with brass fastening button
Adhesive Tape with Glass Fiber Reinforcement
Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
50 m roll
MG153
15
4 210 010 00 00 000
Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
MG158
19
4 210 090 00 00 019
2
Linen Adhesive Tape
50 m roll
4
Plastilina Clay
Order No.
Width in mm
Article No.
MG157-19
19
4 210 080 00 00 019
MG157-25
25
4 210 080 00 00 025
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG157-50
50
4 210 080 00 00 050
MG159
1
4 210 100 00 00 000
160
for sealing laminates
1
3
2
„Modelsoft“ Stockinette
Properties: White, 100% cotton with radial elastic thread accent, high radial compression, fleecy, soft surface, 400% radial elasticity, very air-permeable Application: Special measurement technology with the CASCD application technique, plaster techniques, liner stockinette for patients who wear orthotics, not designed as resin stockinette material Approx. width / mm
Model Ø / cm
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG201-070
70
16–54
1
15,7
4 212 020 01 00 000
MG201-100
100
22–63
1
14,2
4 212 020 02 00 000
MG201-120
120
27–76
1
13,0
4 212 020 03 00 000
2
3.6 Tools
Order No.
Perlon Stockinette
Properties: White, very elastic Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG202-040
40
0,5
46
4 211 010 00 00 004
MG202-060
60
0,5
28
4 211 010 00 00 006
MG202-080
80
0,5
21
4 211 010 00 00 008
MG202-100
100
1
37
4 211 010 00 00 010
MG202-120
120
1
34
4 211 010 00 00 012
MG202-150
150
1
27
4 211 010 00 00 015
MG202-200
200
1
20
4 211 010 00 00 020
MG202-250
250
1
14
4 211 010 00 00 025
MG202-300
300
1
11
4 211 010 00 00 030
Approx. length / m
Article No.
3
„Nylglas“ Stockinette
Properties: White, made of nylon and glass, optimal elasticity Order No.
Approx. width / mm
3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Weight / kg
MG205-070
70
1
44
4 211 050 00 00 007
MG205-090
90
1
36
4 211 050 00 00 009
MG205-100
100
1
32
4 211 050 00 00 010
MG205-120
120
1
27
4 211 050 00 00 012
MG205-150
150
1
24
4 211 050 00 00 015
MG205-200
200
1
18
4 211 050 00 00 020 161
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
1
1
3
2
Nylon Sock
Properties: Stitched seam on one side, 550 mm length, Ø 80 mm, delivery unit: 10 pcs. Application: Use this thin understocking when casting between model and pva film Order No.
Article No.
MG206
4 211 060 02 00 013
2
Nylon Stockinette
Properties: Very thin and flexible, for lamination and vacuum forming Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Weight / kg
Article No.
MG207
130
1
4 211 060 01 00 013
3
Fiberglass Stockinette
Properties: White, elastic, 70% glass and 30% nylon Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Model Ø / cm
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG208-100
100
24–55
1
29
4 211 110 01 00 000
MG208-125
125
30–59
1
27
4 211 110 02 00 000
MG208-170
170
38–72
1
17
4 211 110 03 00 000
MG208-180
180
40–92
1
18
4 211 110 04 00 000
Heavy fiberglass quality MG209-125
125
31–54
1
19
4 211 120 01 00 000
MG209-130
130
30–56
1
18
4 211 120 02 00 000
MG209-195
195
48–90
1
11
4 211 120 03 00 000
MG209-215
215
44–84
1
10
4 211 120 04 00 000
162
3.5 Other Materials
2
Nylon Helanca Stretch Stockinette Properties: White or skin-colored, elastic, smooth pattern for use as a surface cover, very fine knit, good thermoformability, 300% elasticity, 100% nylon, good resin absorption Application: Low strength material for lamination, fine, elastic knit structure, recommended for first and last layers of laminates Order No.
Approx. width / m
Model Ø / cm
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
Pict.
white MG211-080
80
20–57
0,5
38
4 211 080 01 00 000
1
MG211-100
100
25–58
0,5
24
4 211 080 02 00 000
1
MG211-115
115
27–76
0,5
21
4 211 080 03 00 000
1
MG211-130
130
30–100
0,5
12
4 211 080 04 00 000
1
70
16–53
0,5
29
4 211 100 05 00 000
2
skin-colored MG212-070 MG212-075
75
17–62
0,5
22
4 211 100 01 00 000
2
MG212-110
110
26–74
0,5
14
4 211 010 02 00 000
2
MG212-125
125
29–90
0,5
15
4 211 100 03 00 000
2
MG212-130
130
28–110
0,5
15
4 211 100 04 00 000
2
163
3.6 Tools
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
1
1
2
3
Fiberglass Stockinette
Application: For the fabrication of thin-walled laminate reinforcements Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG216-060
60
1
13
4 211 160 00 00 006
MG216-080
80
1
8
4 211 160 00 00 008
MG216-100
100
1
7
4 211 160 00 00 010
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
2
Woven Fiberglass Stockinette
Properties: Highly elastic, double-stretch weave Order No.
Approx. width / mm
MG217-100
100
1
16
4 211 170 00 00 010
MG217-120
120
1
13
4 211 170 00 00 012
MG217-150
150
1
9
4 211 170 00 00 015
MG217-200
200
1
7
4 211 170 00 00 020
MG217-250
250
1
6
4 211 170 00 00 025
MG217-300
300
1
5
4 211 170 00 00 030
3
Woven Carbon Fiber Stockinette
Application: For the fabrication of stable, thin-walled laminates Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Article No.
MG218-050
50
4 211 190 05 00 005
MG218-080
80
4 211 190 08 00 005
MG218-100
100
4 211 190 10 00 005
MG218-120
120
4 211 190 12 00 005
MG219-050
50
4 211 190 05 00 010
MG219-080
80
4 211 190 08 00 010
MG219-100
100
4 211 190 10 00 010
MG219-120
120
4 211 190 12 00 010
Length approx. 5 m
Length approx. 10 m
164
1
2
3
4
Woven Carbon-Fiberglass Stockinette
Application: For the fabrication of stable and thin-walled laminate reinforcements Approx. width / mm
Application
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG220-080
80
BK/AK
8
4 211 200 00 00 008
MG220-100
100
AK
7
4 211 200 00 00 010
2
3.6 Tools
Order No.
Woven Carbon Stockinette
Application: Especially for laminations with carbon epoxy resin, high stiffness Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Application
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG221-100
100
BK
5
4 211 210 00 00 010
MG221-120
120
BK/AK
5
4 211 210 00 00 012
MG221-150
150
AK
5
4 211 210 00 00 015
3
Carbon-Kevlar-Fiberglass Stockinette
Properties: 50% carbon and 50% Kevlar fiber, for heavy duty socket frames with proximal suspension Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Model Ø
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG222-100
100
24–40
0,5
5
4 211 230 01 00 000
MG222-180
180
40–66
0,5
1
4 211 230 02 00 000
4
3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Carbon-Fiberglass Stockinette
Properties: 50% carbon and 50% fiberglass, for thermoformable laminates Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Model Ø
Weight / kg
Approx. length / m
Article No.
MG223-2
110
24–40
0,6
6
4 211 220 01 00 000
MG224-2
200
42–74
0,6
3
4 211 220 04 00 000 165
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination Accessories
1
1
2
3
4
Carbon Webbing
Application: for partial, high-strength reinforcement of laminates, unidirectional Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Approx. length / m Article No.
MG227-050
50
10
4 211 260 50 00 010
MG227-075
75
10
4 211 260 75 00 010
MG228-050
50
20
4 211 260 50 00 020
MG228-075
75
20
4 211 260 75 00 020
2
Carbon Reinforcement Tape
Properties: 98% carbon fiber and 2% fiberglass, for local reinforcement of laminates subject to high bending load. Order No.
Approx. width / mm
Approx. length / m Article No.
MG229-045
45
10
4 211 270 45 00 000
MG229-075
75
10
4 211 270 75 00 000
3
Carbon Matting
Application: for high-strength reinforcement of laminates Order No.
Length x Width / mm
Weight in g/m2
Article No.
MG230-1
1000 x 1000
200
4 211 280 00 00 200
MG230-2
1000 x 1000
245
4 211 280 00 00 245
MG230-5
5000 x 1000
200
4 211 286 00 05 200
MG230-6
5000 x 1000
245
4 211 286 00 05 245
4
Dacron Felt
Properties: White, unpressed polyester fiber as filling material for laminates (e.g., ischial seat) Order No.
Dimension
Article No.
MG232
1 m2
4 211 310 00 00 000
166
Lamination fabrics
1
2
3
4
Lamination fabric Camouflage
consisting of 80% polyamide und 20% elasthan Order No.
Approx. width/cm
Approx. length/cm
Article No.
MG251-20
20
150
4 612 401 01 00 020
Lamination fabric Chess
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.6 Tools
2
consisting of 80% polyamide und 20% elasthan Order No.
Approx. width/cm
Approx. length/cm
Article No.
MG252-20
20
150
4 612 401 02 00 020
3
Lamination fabric Blue Batic
consisting of 80% polyamide und 20% elasthan Order No.
Approx. width/cm
Approx. length/cm
Article No.
MG253-20
20
150
4 612 401 03 00 020
4
3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
NEW
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
Lamination fabric Bianca
consisting of 80% polyamide und 20% elasthan Order No.
Approx. width/cm
Approx. length/cm
Article No.
MG254-20
20
150
4 612 401 04 00 020
167
3 Materials 3.2 Lamination Materials
168
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
1
3
Special Polypropylene
Properties: Specially extruded, no detectable shrinkage, very tough and rigid polypropylene, well suited for products where high rigidity is desired Working temperature: approx. 170–180 °C Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK10-1.5
white
1,5
2000 x 1000
4 213 010 01 96 015
MK10-2
white
2
2000 x 1000
4 213 010 01 96 020
MK10-3
white
3
2000 x 1000
4 213 010 01 96 030
MK10-4
white
4
2000 x 1000
4 213 010 01 96 040
MK10-5
white
5
2000 x 1000
4 213 010 01 96 050
Globolen/Resur
3.6 Tools
2
Properties: Specially extruded polyethylene sheet material, very low shrinkage, weldable and very easy to vacuum-form, good thermoplastic moldability, well suited for spinal orthoses. Working temperature: approx. 160–170 °C Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK11-1W
white
1
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 001
MK11-2W
white
2
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 002
MK11-3W
white
3
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 003
MK11-4W
white
4
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 004
MK11-5W
white
5
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 005
MK11-6W
white
6
2000 x 1000
4 213 070 01 96 006
3
„Supralen“ RCH 500
Properties: High-strength polyethylene material, specially extruded, no detectable shrinkagg, can be welded and chased, well suited for the fabrication of orthoses and foot orthotics Working temperature: approx. 160–180 °C Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK12-2W
white
2
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 002
MK12-3W
white
3
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 003
MK12-4W
white
4
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 004
MK12-5W
white
5
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 005
MK12-6W
white
6
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 006
MK12-8W
white
8
2000 x 1000
4 213 020 00 96 008
3.5 Other Materials
2
1
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
PP = polypropylene PE = polyethylene 169
3 Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
1
1
3
2
Polydor®
Properties: Polyacrylic Working temperature: approx. 170–180 °C Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK16-3
orange, transparent
3
610 x 915
4 213 050 00 73 030
MK16-3.5
orange, transparent
3,5
610 x 915
4 213 050 00 73 035
3
Polysplint A
Properties: Low-temperature material, well suited for hand orthoses, etc. Working temperature: approx. 80°C submerged in water bath Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK36-3
skin-colored
3
920 x 610
4 213 270 00 91 003
3
ipocarbon
Properties: Thermoplastic carbon-fiber composite material for orthotic appliances. Working temperature: approx. 190 °C Order No.
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK31-2
2
300 x 450
4 213 170 01 00 002
MK31-3
3
300 x 450
4 213 170 01 00 003
MK32-2
2
600 x 450
4 213 170 02 00 002
MK32-3
3
600 x 450
4 213 170 02 00 003
MK33-2
2
1200 x 900
4 213 170 03 00 002
PE = polyethylene 170
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.5 Other Materials
1
2
Göplex® Plus
Properties: Clear copolyester material, no detectable shrinkage, for the fabrication of load-supporting prosthetic test sockets (only for short term use) Working temperature: approx. 150–170 °C Order No.
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK25-09
9
400 x 400
4 213 110 01 00 009
MK25-12
12
400 x 400
4 213 110 01 00 012
MK25-15
15
400 x 400
4 213 110 01 00 015
MK25-09
9
1200 x 800
4 213 110 03 00 009
MK26-12
12
1200 x 800
4 213 110 03 00 012
MK26-15
15
1200 x 800
4 213 110 03 00 015
Göplex® is a registered trademark
2
Thermoflex AB
The new thermoplastic deep drawing material Thermoflex AB with antibacterial effect protects the skin and the prosthesis socket against a wide range of microorganisms, such as fungi and bacteria. • for the production of flexible inner sockets • prevents discolorations on the socket • minimizes the mechanical stress on the skin • antibacterial ingredient remains permanently • working temperature: 320°F/160°C
Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK24-12
white
12
400 x 400
4 695 500 00 01 012
171
3.6 Tools
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
NEW
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3 Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
NEW
1
1
2
3
Thermoflex, soft
Properties: Transparent, for very flexible socket liners Working temperature: approx. 150–170 °C Order No.
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK27-09
9
400 x 400
4 213 130 01 00 009
MK27-12
12
400 x 400
4 213 130 01 00 012
MK27-14
14
400 x 400
4 213 130 01 00 014
MK28-03
3
1000 x 1000
4 213 130 03 00 003
MK28-04
4
1000 x 1000
4 213 130 03 00 004
MK29-06
6
1200 x 800
4 213 130 04 00 006
MK29-09
9
1200 x 800
4 213 130 04 00 009
2
Thermoflex, rigid
Properties: Milky/transparent, for flexible socket liners Working temperature: approx. 150–170 °C Order No.
Approx. thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK30-09
9
400 x 400
4 213 140 01 00 009
MK30-12
12
400 x 400
4 213 140 01 00 012
3
Thermoflex STIFF
The thermoplastic deep drawing material Thermoflex STIFF has a high mechanical strength and shiny and transparent surface. It is especially suitable for the production of transparent sockets. - for the fabrication of self-supporting test sockets - transparent to the optical controll of the stump - very high impact and breaking strength - working temperature: 140°C- 160°C Order No.
Color
Approx. thickness / mm Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MK37-10
transparent
10
400 x 400
4 690 130 00 90 010
MK37-12
transparent
12
400 x 400
4 690 130 00 90 012
MK37-15
transparent
15
400 x 400
4 690 130 00 90 015
172
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Globotop/Göforlen
Properties: Polyolefin foam, dimensionally stable, weldable and bondable, thermoformable, washable Application: suitable for the fabrication of foot orthotics, padding of orthoses and for inner soft sockets, shore hardness 30* Working temperature: approx. 110–130°C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP20-02H
skin-colored
2
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 002
MP20-03H
skin-colored
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 003
MP20-04H
skin-colored
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 004
MP20-05H
skin-colored
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 005
MP20-06H
skin-colored
6
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 006
MP20-07H
skin-colored
7
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 007
MP20-08H
skin-colored
8
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 008
MP20-10H
skin-colored
10
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 010
MP20-15H
skin-colored
15
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 91 015
MP20-02B
blue
2
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 93 002
MP20-03B
blue
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 93 003
MP20-04B
blue
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 93 004
MP20-05B
blue
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 93 005
MP20-06B
blue
6
1100 x 1100
4 214 010 00 93 006
2
Globotop/Göforlen, perforated
Properties: Polyolefin foam, dimensionally stable, weldable and bondable, thermoformable, washable Application: suitable for fabrication of foot orthotics and padding of orthoses, shore hardness 30* Working temperature: approx. 110–130 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP21-02H
skin-colored
2
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 91 002
MP21-03H
skin-colored
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 91 003
MP21-04H
skin-colored
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 91 004
MP21-05H
skin-colored
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 91 005
MP21-02B
blue
2
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 93 002
MP21-03B
blue
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 93 003
MP21-04B
blue
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 93 004
MP21-05B
blue
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 93 005
MP21-04BR
brown
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 020 00 95 004
*Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 173
3.5 Other Materials
1
2
3.6 Tools
1
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
1
1
2
3
Pryx®
Properties: EVA foam, light, elastic, sterilized, for the fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 45* Working temperature: approx. 90–120 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP23-06W
white
6
800 x 500
4 214 210 00 89 006
MP23-06BR
brown
6
800 x 500
4 214 210 00 95 006
MP23-14BR
brown
14
800 x 500
4 214 210 00 95 014
Due to the production the listed measures may differ in size. 2
Globofom
Properties: EVA foam, very soft, very light, for padding of orthoses and for the fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 25* Working temperature: approx. 90–120 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP24-03B
blue
3
1150 x 1150
4 214 180 00 93 003
MP24-06B
blue
6
1150 x 1150
4 214 180 00 93 006
3
Globomoll
Properties: EVA foam, soft, very light, for padding of orthoses or fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 35* Working temperature: approx. 90–120 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP25-04W
white
4
950 x 950
4 214 190 00 89 004
MP25-06W
white
6
950 x 950
4 214 190 00 89 006
MP25-15W
white
15
950 x 950
4 214 190 00 89 015
MP25-06B
blue
6
950 x 950
4 214 190 00 93 006
EVA = ethylene vinyl acetate *Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 174
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
2
Globelast
Properties: EVA foam, medium soft, light, for the fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 45* Working temperature: approx. 90–120 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP26-06W
white
6
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 89 006
white
15
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 89 015
blue
6
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 93 006
2
3.6 Tools
MP26-15W MP26-06B
3.5 Other Materials
1
EVA Soft Foam
Properties: Very soft, smooth, for the fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 40* Working temperature: approx. 90–120 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP27-03
gray
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 250 00 86 003
MP27-05
gray
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 250 00 86 005
Globomoll, Globelast and Globofom Application: Fabrication of Foot Orthotics (e.g., TRIactive) Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP26-06GR
Globelast
gray
6
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 90 006
MP26-15GR
Globelast
gray
15
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 90 015
MP26-06BL
Globelast
blue
6
950 x 950
4 214 200 00 94 006
MP25-06GR
Globomoll
gray
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 190 00 90 006
MP25-06BL
Globomoll
blue
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 190 00 94 006
MP24-05BL
Globofom
blue
5
1050 x 1100
4 214 180 00 94 005
MP24-03BL
Globofom
blue
3
1050 x 1100
4 214 180 00 94 003
EVA = ethylene vinyl acetate *Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 175
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Plastazote Properties: good thermoplastic formability, moderate dimensional stability, Application: for padding orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 15–20*, Working temperature: approx. 130–150 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP28-02W
white
2
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 002
MP28-03W
white
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 003
MP28-04W
white
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 004
MP28-05W
white
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 005
MP28-06W
white
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 006
MP28-09W
white
9
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 009
MP28-10W
white
10
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 010
MP28-12W
white
12
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 012
MP28-15W
white
15
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 015
MP28-18W
white
18
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 018
MP28-20W
white
20
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 020
MP28-25W
white
25
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 89 025
MP28-02H
skin-colored
2
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 002
MP28-03H
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 003
MP28-04H
skin-colored
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 004
MP28-05H
skin-colored
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 005
MP28-06H
skin-colored
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 006
MP28-09H
skin-colored
9
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 009
MP28-10H
skin-colored
10
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 010
MP28-12H
skin-colored
12
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 012
MP28-15H
skin-colored
15
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 015
MP28-18H
skin-colored
18
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 018
MP28-20H
skin-colored
20
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 020
MP28-25H
skin-colored
25
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 91 025
MP28-02B
blue
2
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 002
MP28-03B
blue
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 003
MP28-04B
blue
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 004
MP28-05B
blue
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 005
MP28-06B
blue
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 006
MP28-09B
blue
9
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 009
MP28-12B
blue
12
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 012
MP28-15B
blue
15
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 015
MP28-18B
blue
18
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 018
MP28-20B
blue
20
1000 x 1000
4 214 050 00 93 020
*Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 176
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP30-03W
white
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 89 003
MP30-04W
white
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 89 004
MP30-05W
white
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 89 005
MP30-06W
white
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 89 006
MP30-03H
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 91 003
MP30-04H
skin-colored
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 91 004
MP30-05H
skin-colored
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 91 005
MP30-06H
skin-colored
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 91 006
MP30-03B
blue
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 93 003
MP30-04B
blue
4
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 93 004
MP30-05B
blue
5
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 93 005
MP30-06B
blue
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 060 00 93 006
*Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 177
3.6 Tools
Properties: good thermoplastic formability, moderate dimensional stability Application: for padding orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 15–20* Working temperature: approx. 130–150 °C
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
Plastazote, perforated
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
1
3
2
1
Globosoft
Properties: PE foam, very soft, very light Application: for padding orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, thermoformable, shore hardness 25* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP32-3
gray
3
1200 x 1000
4 214 230 00 86 003
MP32-5
gray
5
1200 x 1000
4 214 230 00 86 005
2
Globoflex
Properties: Globofit PU foam in 3 mm thickness (shore hardness 0) covered with 3 mm skin-colored PE foam (shore hardness 25*), for the fabrication of foot orthotics, especially for reducing pressure spots (e.g., in case of diabetes) Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP33
blue/skin-colored
6
950 x 950
4 214 280 00 91 060
3
Globoflex, perforated
Properties: Globofit PU foam in 1.5 mm thickness (high energy return), covered with 3 mm skin-colored PE foam (very soft, very light), shore hardness 25* Application: for the fabrication of foot orthotics, especially for reducing pressure spots Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP34
skin-colored
4,5
950 x 950
4 214 280 01 91 045
PE = polyethylene PU = polyurethane *Shore hardness tolerance Âą15% 178
1
2
Globofit
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Properties: dimensionally stable, air-permeable PU foam (high energy return, permanent elasticity, shock absorbent, grindable, skinfriendly) Application: for padding orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 0* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
skin-colored
1,5
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 00 91 015
MP35-1.5H MP35-3H
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 00 91 030
MP35-6H
skin-colored
6
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 00 91 060
MP35-9H
skin-colored
9
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 00 91 090
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 01 91 030
Both sides roughened MP36-3H perforated MP37-1.5H
skin-colored
1,5
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 02 91 015
MP37-3H
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 260 02 91 030
2
Podion di Alcantara® with Globofit
Properties: Skin-colored Globofit PU foam covered with Podion di Alcantara® Application: for padding orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, shore hardness 0* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP38-2H
skin-colored
2
1000 x 1000
4 214 270 00 91 002
MP38-3H
skin-colored
3
1000 x 1000
4 214 270 00 91 003
MP38-2B
blue
2
1000 x 1000
4 214 270 00 93 002
PU = polyurethane *Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 179
3.6 Tools
One side roughened
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Circumference A
ØA
ØB
Circumference B 1
1
2
„Göforlen“ Thermo-Cones
Properties: Prefabricated cone of thermoformable material, for the fabrication of inner soft sockets Working temperature: approx. 150 °C, shore hardness 30* Order No.
Application
Wall Thickness in mm
ØA in mm
ØB in mm
Length C in mm
Article No.
MP39-160
Transtibial
6,5
90
160
390
4 214 090 00 00 160
MP39-180
Transfemoral
7,5
90
180
500
4 214 090 00 00 180
2
ipoform Soft Socket
Properties: Prefabricated, cone-shaped soft liner blanks for prosthetic socket liners Working temperature: approx. 160 °C, shore hardness 45* Order No.
Thickness in mm
Circumference A in mm
Circumference B in mm
Length in mm
Article No.
MP40-1
4
150
380
500
4 214 100 01 00 004
MP40-2
4
160
400
500
4 214 100 02 00 004
MP40-3
4
170
420
500
4 214 100 03 00 004
MP40-4
4
180
440
500
4 214 100 04 00 004
MP40-5
4
190
460
500
4 214 100 05 00 004
MP41-1
5
150
380
500
4 214 100 01 00 005
MP41-2
5
160
400
500
4 214 100 02 00 005
MP41-3
5
170
420
500
4 214 100 03 00 005
MP41-4
5
180
440
500
4 214 100 04 00 005
MP41-5
5
190
460
500
4 214 100 05 00 005
MP42-1
6
150
380
500
4 214 100 01 00 006
MP42-2
6
160
400
500
4 214 100 02 00 006
MP42-3
6
170
420
500
4 214 100 03 00 006
MP42-4
6
180
440
500
4 214 100 04 00 006
MP42-5
6
190
460
500
4 214 100 05 00 006
MP43-3
7
170
420
500
4 214 100 03 00 007
MP43-4
7
180
440
500
4 214 100 04 00 007
*Shore hardness tolerances _+ 15 % 180
ipoform/Tepefom
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.5 Other Materials
1
2
Properties: PE foam, good thermoplastic formability, grindable, bondable, suitable for soft inner sockets, waterproof, good skin tolerance under load, shore hardness 45*, density 0.2 g/cm3 Working temperature: approx. 160 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP44-02
skin-colored
2
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 002
MP44-03
skin-colored
3
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 003
MP44-04
skin-colored
4
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 004
MP44-05
skin-colored
5
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 005
MP44-06
skin-colored
6
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 006
MP44-07
skin-colored
7
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 007
MP44-08
skin-colored
8
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 008
MP44-10
skin-colored
10
1100 x 1100
4 214 080 00 00 010
2
Lunasoft SL
Properties: EVA foam, good thermoplastic formability, grindable, bondable, suitable for soft inner sockets, orthoses and fabrication of foot orthotics, waterproof, good skin tolerance under load, smooth, medium soft, shore hardness 40*, Density 0.2 g/cm3, working temperature: approx. 120–170 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP46-2H
skin-colored
2
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 002
MP46-3H
skin-colored
3
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 003
MP46-4H
skin-colored
4
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 004
MP46-5H
skin-colored
5
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 005
MP46-6H
skin-colored
6
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 006
MP46-8H
skin-colored
8
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 91 008
MP46-2M
Multicolored
2
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 82 002
MP46-3M
Multicolored
3
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 82 003
MP46-2SW
black/white
2
1300 x 900
4 214 110 00 81 002
MP46-2DB
dark blue
2
1300 x 900
4 214 100 10 93 002
PE = polyethylene EVA = ethylene vinyl acetate *Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 181
3.6 Tools
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Lunairmed Properties: Skin-colored, good thermoplastic formability, grindable, bondable, for all types of padding, reduction of pressure spots, dimensional stability, waterproof, good skin tolerance, shore hardness 18* Working temperature: Approx. 120â&#x20AC;&#x201C;170 °C Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP49-02
skin-colored
2
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 002
MP49-03
skin-colored
3
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 003
MP49-04
skin-colored
4
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 004
MP49-05
skin-colored
5
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 005
MP49-06
skin-colored
6
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 006
MP49-08
skin-colored
8
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 008
MP49-12
skin-colored
12
1280 x 980
4 214 130 01 00 012
MP50-03
skin-colored
3
1280 x 980
4 214 130 02 00 003
MP50-06
skin-colored
6
1280 x 980
4 214 130 02 00 006
perforated
*Shore hardness tolerances _+ 15 % 182
Microcellular Rubber
Properties: Closed-cell rubber for orthotic applications, grindable, bondable, prevents slippage due to excellent grip, waterproof, highly elastic Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
black
2
2000 x 1000
4 215 020 02 00 002
black
4
2000 x 1000
4 215 020 02 00 004
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials 3.6 Tools
MP54-2 MP54-4
3.5 Other Materials
2
1
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
2
ipocon Gel Sheets
Properties: Made of pure silicone gel, viscoelastic, for partial pressure relief, without Lycra coating to reduce spot pressure and for fabrication of foot orthotics (e.g., in cases of diabetes). Order No.
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP57-3
3
400 x 300
4 215 030 00 00 003
MP57-4
4
400 x 300
4 215 030 00 00 004
183
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
Foam Sheet Materials
1
1
2
3
PORON®
Properties: PU soft bedding material with excellent shock absorption and cushioning properties, for padding of diabetic foot orthotics, good skin tolerance, grindable, bondable, one side roughened, shore hardness 0* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP61-30
salmon pink
3
137 x 100
4 215 070 00 95 003
2
PORON® Dual Layer
Properties: Multifunctional compound material PORON 2 in salmon pink (soft, shock absorbing), with 2 mm blue Globofit (high energy return), for sports insoles, shore hardness 0* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP62
salmon pink/blue
4
1400 x 1000
4 215 070 01 77 004
3
Latex Foam
Properties: easily grindable, e. g., for padding in the toe area, shore hardness 0* Order No.
Color
Thickness / mm
Approx. dimensions / mm
Article No.
MP63-03
skin-colored
3
1500 x 1000
4 215 080 00 69 003
MP63-06
skin-colored
6
1500 x 1000
4 215 080 00 69 006
MP63-10
skin-colored
10
1500 x 1000
4 215 080 00 69 010
PU = polyurethane *Shore hardness tolerance ±15% 184
EVA Thermocork
3
3.5 Other Materials
1
3
Flexocork
Properties: grindable, thermoformable, bondable, for fabrication of foot orthotics, leg compensations, foot inlays, etc. Working temperature: approx. 120 °C
Properties: grindable, bondable, light, elastic Order No.
Thickness in mm
Approx. size in mm
Article No.
Order No.
Thickness in mm
Approx. size in mm
Article No.
MP72-02
2
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 002
MP72-03
3
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 003
MP70-04
4
1020 x 820
4 216 040 00 00 004
MP72-04
4
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 004
MP70-06
6
1020 x 820
4 216 040 00 00 006
MP72-05
5
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 005
MP72-06
6
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 006
MP72-08
8
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 008
MP72-10
10
1000 x 500
4 216 010 00 00 010
2
Elastra® Cork
Properties: grindable, thermoformable, bondable, cork/latex special mixture, elastic, dimensionally stable, light Working temperature: approx. 130 °C Order No.
Thickness in mm
Approx. size in mm
Article No.
MP71-02
2
500 x 560
4 216 050 00 00 002
MP71-04
4
500 x 560
4 216 050 00 00 004
MP71-06
6
500 x 560
4 216 050 00 00 006
MP71-08
8
500 x 560
4 216 050 00 00 008
185
3.6 Tools
2
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Cork Sheet Materials
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
3 Materials 3.4 Padding Materials
186
2
3
4
5
Xn
4
Light Putty
Properties: Acrylic-based lightweight putty, fast curing, easily grindable, can be colored, for filling or modifying prosthetic sockets. Order No. Content / kg Article No. 1
M10-1
4 217 070 00 00 010
Mixing ratio: 100 parts to 3 parts curing paste
2
AKEMI Fast-Curing Putty
Light Putty SL
Properties: Very light, semi-elastic filling compound.Well modeled, very easy to sand. Use in cosmetic applications. Order No
Content / l
Artikelnummer
M14-1
1
4 695 010 00 00 000
Mixing ratio: 3-4% Hardener paste or 8-10% Hardener powder
5
3.6 Tools
1
Hardener Paste
Properties: Skin-colored, delivered with curing paste. Lightweight, fast curing, grindable, can be colored
for Acrylic and Polyester Resins Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
MG119-0.2
0,2
4 205 010 00 00 200
M12-1
1
4 217 020 01 00 010
MG119-0.5
0,5
4 205 010 00 00 500
Mixing ratio: 100 parts to 3 parts curing paste
3
Acrylic Sealing Resin Paste
Properties: Acrylic-based sealing putty for heavy-duty bonding Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
M13-0.5
0,5
4 217 050 00 00 005
Curing powder in % Reaction-free by weight of resin time
Curing after initial reaction
2%
5 min.
5 min.
3%
3 min.
3 min.
Mixing ratio: 100 parts to 3 parts curing paste Irritant
3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Plastic Putties
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.5 Other Materials
Flammable 187
3 Materials 3.5 Other Materials
Adhesives and Thinners
1
2
1
3
Thinner
Properties: For Special Contact Adhesive Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
M20-1
1
4 219 020 00 00 010
2
Plastic Adhesive
Properties: Highly elastic, for flexible plastics, foam rubber and cosmetic covers, can be brushed and sprayed. Order No.
Color
Content / kg
Article No.
M21-1
transparent
1
4 219 030 90 00 010
M21-4.6
transparent
4,6
4 219 030 90 00 046
3
Silicone Adhesive
Properties: Bonds silicone with leather, textiles and plastic Order No.
Content / kg
Article No.
M22-0.1
0,1
4 219 170 00 00 001
Irritant
188
Flammable
2
1
3.5 Other Materials
1
3.4 Padding Materials
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
3.2 Lamination Materials
Adhesives
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.5 Other Materials
Spray Adhesive for Carbon Materials
Application: Fixation of carbon-fiber cloths and woven carbon fiber stockinettes Content / kg
Article No.
M24-0.4
0,4
4 219 130 00 00 400
2
3.6 Tools
Order No.
Loctite速 222 and 243
Application: Securing screws with soluble bond Order No.
Description
Content / kg
Thread
Features
Article No.
M25-1
222
0,05
up to M 36
highly soluble (6 Nm)
4 219 150 01 00 050
M25-2
243
0,05
up to M 36
low solubility (20 Nm)
4 219 150 02 00 050
Flammable 189
3 Materials 3.5 Other Materials
CASCD Carving Blanks These carving blanks have been exclusively developed for use with the CASCD Carving Machine. Available in various standard sizes, as modular blanks for spinal models, and as soft foam blanks for the fabrication of cosmetic foam covers for transfemoral prostheses. Ø 60
1000
1000
670
470
470
Ø 60
Ø 45
Ø 30 1
2
Ø 30
3
4
Positive Model Carving Blank
1
Order No.
CASCD No.
Description
Length in mm
Ø distal / mm
Ø proximal / mm Article No.
M30-1
008582
Transfemoral M
445
150
290
4 235 010 01 00 000
M30-2
008583
Transfemoral L
500
175
340
4 235 010 02 00 000
M30-3
008584
Transtibial
450
130
220
4 235 010 03 00 000
M30-4
008585
Knee Disarticulation
640
180
220
4 235 010 04 00 000
M30-5
008586
Knee Orthosis
800
150
275
4 235 010 05 00 000
Modular Carving Blanks
2
Order No.
CASCD No.
Ø / mm
Length / mm
Article No.
M31-2
040015
410
500
4 235 020 02 00 000
M31-3
040018
410
200
4 235 020 05 00 000
M31-4
040019
530
200
4 235 020 06 00 000
M31-5
040016
530
500
4 235 020 03 00 000
3
+
4
Cosmetic Cover Blank for Transfemoral Prostheses
Order No.
CASCD No.
Bore type
Version
Article No.
M32-1
008589
2-step bore
Model Ø: < 420 mm
4 235 030 01 00 000
M32-3
008617
3-step bore
Model Ø: < 420 mm
4 235 030 03 00 000
M32-4
008568
3-step bore
Model Ø: > 420 mm
4 235 030 04 00 000
190
3.2 Lamination Materials
Measuring Tools
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Ischial Containment Measuring Gauge
Article No.
WZ100
4 301 010 00 00 000 3.4 Padding Materials
Order No.
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
This ischial containment caliper has been designed for the determination of soft-tissue and skeletal widths for ischial containment sockets.The measuring arm used for the female pelvis has a 45° angle, and the arm for the male pelvis has a 30° angle. In addition, this caliper may be used to determine all other measurements up to 24 cm.
TLSO Measuring Caliper
Article No.
WZ101
4 301 020 00 00 000
3.6 Tools
Order No.
3.5 Other Materials
This measuring caliper has been designed to take the measurements required for the fabrication of spinal orthoses. Measures 0–80 cm.
Hip Leveling Guide Aluminum with plastic side extensions, to check leg length discrepancies.
Order No.
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
WZ105
330
260
4 301 090 00 00 000
Tools for Plaster Work Replacement Blade for Plaster Smoothing Tool Order No.
Version
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
E-WZ04
flat
280
30
4 320 030 00 00 000
191
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Files and Rasps Surform Rasp Holder with/without blade Order No.
Version
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
WZ118-1
with blade
250
270
4 319 010 01 00 000
WZ118-2
without blade
250
230
4 319 010 02 00 000
Surform Rasp Holder with round blade and handle Order No.
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
WZ119
250
150
4 319 020 00 00 000
Order No.
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
E-WZ06
250
40
4 319 030 00 00 000
Order No.
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
E-WZ08
250
40
4 319 050 00 00 000
Order No.
Length / mm
Weight / g
Article No.
E-WZ09
250
35
4 319 060 00 00 000
Order No.
Capacity
Weight / g
Article No.
WZ129-2
900
330
4 335 030 02 00 000
Surform Standard Blade flat
Surform Blade half-round
Surform Blade round
Storage Container Solvent-proof plastic, with flat brush
192
3.2 Lamination Materials
Laminating and Thermoforming Tools
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Cosmetic Foam Shaper
Article No.
WZ144
4 338 170 00 00 000
3.5 Other Materials
3.4 Padding Materials
Order No.
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
Used to shape soft foam cosmetic covers. The steel bristles are elastically embedded, combining the advantages of a wire brush with those of conventional sanding carving tools in the shaping process. (thread 5/8“)
Accessories Thread adapter 5/8“ to M16 Order No.
Article No.
E-WZ14
4 338 180 00 00 000
Particle Filter Mask Particle class P1, with air discharge valve, delivery unit: 10 pcs. Order No.
Article No.
WZ151
4 341 010 00 00 000
193
3.6 Tools
Accessory for Cosmetic Foam Thread Adapter (5/8“ to M16)
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Laminating and Thermoforming Tools Laminating Jig Facilitates perfect two-channel suction by using a model holding pylon. All pylons with diameters between 8 and 25 mm can be easily clamped into the laminating jig. The laminating jig is directly fixed on the workbench or in the vise. Can be easily disassembled and cleaned. Version 1 (Ø 100 mm) is especially designed for lamination of upper extremity prosthetics and other small models.
Order No.
Ø 100 mm
1
Ø / mm
Article No.
Pict.
WZ155-1
100
4 339 010 00 00 100
1
WZ155-2
130
4 339 010 00 00 130
2
Ø 130 mm
6
2
3 2
12
1
13
7 11 9
10
8
4
14 5
Replacement Parts for Laminating Jig Order No.
Description
Ø / mm
E-WZ42
Laminating Jig (basic equipment)
E-WZ43
Laminating Jig (basic equipment)
E-WZ44
Main Tube for Laminating Jig
E-WZ45
Vacuum Forming Disk
100
E-WZ46
Vacuum Forming Disk
130
E-WZ47
Vacuum Forming Disk
E-WZ48
Vacuum Forming Disk
E-WZ49
Thickness
Size
Article No.
Pict.
100
4 339 011 01 00 100
1
130
4 339 011 01 00 130
as 1
4 339 011 16 00 000
no pict.
thick (22 mm)
4 339 011 02 00 100
2
thick (22 mm)
4 339 011 02 00 130
as 2
100
thin (6 mm)
4 339 011 03 00 100
3
130
thin (6 mm)
4 339 011 03 00 130
as 3
Hose nozzle
4 339 011 04 00 000
4
E-WZ50
Bench-top vise supporter
4 339 011 05 00 000
5
E-WZ51
Double-pylon clamp vise, complete
4 339 011 06 00 000
6
E-WZ52
Rubber stopper
small
4 339 011 07 00 000
7
E-WZ53
Rubber stopper
large
4 339 011 08 00 000
as 7
E-WZ55
Headless screw M12 x 20
4 339 011 10 00 000
9
E-WZ56
Countersunk head screw M5 x 12
4 339 011 11 00 000
10
E-WZ57
Flat-head screw M6 x 25
4 339 011 12 00 000
11
E-WZ58
Clamping ring
4 339 011 13 00 000
12
E-WZ59
Vise supporter
100
4 339 011 14 00 000
13
E-WZ60
Vise supporter
130
4 339 011 15 00 000
as 13
E-WZ61
O-Ring for Laminating Jig
4 339 011 17 00 000
no pict.
E-WZ67
Clamping lever for double pylon clamp vise M 12 (handle only)
4 340 011 05 00 000
14
194
3.1 Plaster Fabrication Materials
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Inside dimension / mm
Article No.
WZ156
265/320
4 340 010 00 00 000
3.4 Padding Materials
Order No.
3.3 Plastic Sheet Materials
The vacuum-forming system has been designed for the blister vacuum-forming of transtibial and transfemoral prosthetic positive models. It consists of aholding frame and two holding frame plates, one for transfemoral (large opening, Ø 320 mm), and one for transtibial prostheses (small opening, Ø 265 mm).
3.2 Lamination Materials
Vacuum Forming System
3
7 3.5 Other Materials
1
8 2a 4
9
2
9
6
5
12 3.6 Tools
10
11
Order No.
Description
Ø / mm
Article No.
Pict.
E-WZ62
Holding frame
265/320
4 340 011 01 00 000
1
E-WZ63
Vacuum forming disk unit, compl.
265/320
4 340 011 02 00 000
2
E-WZ64
ipocon Ring
270
4 340 011 03 00 000
3
E-WZ65
Holding frame plate
265
4 340 011 04 00 265
4
E-WZ66
Holding frame plate
320
4 340 011 04 00 320
as 4
E-WZ50
Bench-top vise supporter
4 339 011 05 00 000
5
E-WZ51
Double-pylon clamp vise, complete
4 339 011 06 00 000
6
E-WZ67
Clamping lever for double pylon clamp vise M12 (handle only)
4 340 011 05 00 000
7
E-WZ68
Supporter for holding frame, 200 mm length
4 340 011 06 00 000
8
E-WZ69
Handle screw for holding frame, 1 pc.
4 340 011 07 00 000
10
E-WZ70
Handle screw for holding frame, 4 pc.
4 340 011 08 00 000
9
E-WZ71
Foot control valve vacuum forming system
4 340 011 09 00 000
11
E-WZ72
Cylinder screw M6 x 14
4 340 011 10 00 000
12
E-WZ73
Disk Ø 10.5
4 340 011 11 00 000
no pict.
E-WZ74
Retrofitting set for vacuum forming disk
4 340 011 12 00 000
no pict.
E-WZ75
Vacuum forming disk, incl. ipocon ring and vertical rod
4 340 011 13 00 000
2a
E-WZ76
PE supporter, Ø = 290 mm
4 340 011 14 00 000
no pict.
195
3 Materials 3.6 Tools
Oscillating Saw
196
Order No.
Description
Article No.
WZ157
Oscillating Saw
4 342 019 00 00 000
Order No.
Description
Article No.
E-WZ77
Saw blade Ø 50 mm, for plastics
4 342 019 01 00 050
E-WZ78
Saw blade Ø 65 mm, for plastics
4 342 019 01 00 065
E-WZ79
Saw blade Ø 50 mm, for plaster
4 342 019 02 00 050
E-WZ80
Saw blade Ø 65 mm, for plaster
4 342 019 02 00 065
unique prosthetic solutions
4
Measurement Sheets
•
BECKER, Hyperextension Orthosis
•
BOSTON, Spinal Orthosis
•
Hand Orthoses
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de 197
198
Company stamp
Fax no. +49(0)36628663377 Date:
Orthotist‘s name:
Measurement Sheet for BECKER Hyperextension Orthosis
Patient information: Name:
Sex: M
F
Age:
Size:
Weight:
Application:
Diagnosis:
IMPORTANT! Patient must lie supine, if possible with dorsolumbar support. A = length of trunk from superior edge of sternum to center of pubic bone minus 6 cm B = M-L measurement of the chest from axilla to axilla C = M-L measurement of the pelvis from iliac crest to iliac crest at the level of the anterior iliac spines
Measurement Guide for Dist. A: 35
small
B cm
A
40
45
medium
50
55
39 cm–46 cm
60
65 cm
44 cm–56 cm 48 cm–58 cm
large
(The anterior pads may be adjusted resulting in an additional height A of 5 cm.)
Measurement Guide for Dist. B and C
cm
25
C
small medium cm
Size of the orthosis
Thoracolumbar Pad
small
standard
medium
extra-wide
30
large
35
40 cm
27 cm–33 cm 28 cm–36 cm 30 cm–39 cm
large
199
200
Company stamp
Fax no. +49(0)36628663377 Date:
Orthotist‘s name:
Measurement Sheet for BOSTON Spinal Orthosis
Patient information: Name:
Sex: M
F
Age:
Size:
Weight:
Application:
Diagnosis:
A Size
Circumference Circumference Circumference of waist of hips* of chest (below sternum) 66
51
71
58,5
46
71
71
61
76
63,5
51
76
3
76
71
81
3D
74
66
81
4
84
76
86,5
1 1D 2 2D
A cm
B cm
C cm
Dorsal Reinforcement Stays (available in pairs) moldable covered with Dacron
Length
Closure Straps
C
B
4D
69
58,5
86,5
5
89
81
91,5
5D
76
66
91,5
6
94
86,5
96,5
6D
84
74
96,5
7
99
91,5
101,5
7D
91,5
81
101,5
8
109
96,5
109
8D
91,5
84
109 * above the trochanter
Size of orthosis
Hyperextension Bars (Available in pairs) with continuous adjustment of the height and the angular position of the subclavicular pads.
Lordosis Angle
0° (only for men)
15°
Quantity
0°
21 cm
15°
26 cm 29 cm 32 cm
Length
34 cm
16 cm
36 cm
18 cm
40 cm
21 cm
43 cm
24 cm
Quantity
medium large 201
202
Company stamp
Fax no. +49(0)36628663377 Date:
Orthotist‘s name:
Measurement Sheet for Hand Orthoses
Patient information: Name: Diagnosis:
Sex: M
F
Age:
Size:
Weight:
Application:
Side left
small
right
medium 7.1–8.5 cm large
5.5 –7.0 cm
8.6–11.0 cm
Model selection only for Model 4
DAHO Model 1 DAHO Model 2.1
A
X-large > 11 cm
DAHO Model 2.2 DAHO Model 2.3 DAHO Model 2.4 DAHO Model 3, incl. glove
cm Hand width at level of metatarsophalangeal joints
DAHO Model 4 DAHO Model 4 (perforated)
Option für TYP 2.1–2.4 Thumb extensor
203
204
205
206
unique prosthetic solutions
Benelux Bauerfeind Benelux B.V. Waarderveldweg 1 NL-2031 BK Haarlem Netherlands Phone +31 (0) 23 531 94 27 Fax +31 (0) 23 532 19 70 E-mail info@bauerfeind.nl www.bauerfeind.nl Belgium Phone +32 (0) 2 527 40 60 Fax +32 (0) 2 502 94 10 E-mail info@bauerfeind.be www.bauerfeind.be
Croatia Bauerfeind d.o.o. Goleška 20 HR-10020 Zagreb Phone +385 (0) 1 65 42 855 Fax +385 (0) 1 65 42 860 E-mail info@bauerfeind.hr
Serbia Bauerfeind d.o.o. Miloja Djaka 6 CS-11000 Beograd Phone +381 (0) 11 26 65 999 Fax +381 (0) 11 26 69 745 E-mail info@bauerfeind.co.yu
Republic of Macedonia Bauerfeind Dooel Skopje 50 Divizija 24 a MK-1000 Skopje Phone +389 (0) 2 3179 002 Fax +389 (0) 2 3179 004 E-mail info@bauerfeind.mk
Spain Bauerfeind Ibérica, S.A. Historiador Diago 13 E-46007 Valencia Phone +34 96 385 66 33 Fax +34 96 385 66 99 E-mail info@bauerfeind.es
United Arab Emirates Bauerfeind Middle East FZ-LLC Dubai Healthcare City P.O. Box 505116 UAE-Dubai Phone +971 4 4335-685 Fax +971 4 4370-344 E-mail info@bauerfeind.ae
Bosnia and Herzegovina Bauerfeind d.o.o. Midžić Mahala 133 BA-77000 Bihać Phone +387 (0) 37 313 198 Fax +387 (0) 37 319 074 E-mail bauerfeind@bosnia.ba Uniprox GmbH & Co. KG Heinrich-Heine-Strasse 4 07937 Zeulenroda-Triebes Germany
Phone Fax E-mail
+49 (0) 36628-66-33 00 +49 (0) 36628-66-33 55 info@uniprox.de
A company of the Bauerfeind Group . www.uniprox.de
Rev.4 - 01/13_49000010000011